1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 /*
3 * mac80211 <-> driver interface
4 *
5 * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
6 * Copyright 2006-2007 Jiri Benc <[email protected]>
7 * Copyright 2007-2010 Johannes Berg <[email protected]>
8 * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9 * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
10 * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2024 Intel Corporation
11 */
12
13 #ifndef MAC80211_H
14 #define MAC80211_H
15
16 #include <linux/bug.h>
17 #include <linux/kernel.h>
18 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
19 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
20 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
21 #include <linux/lockdep.h>
22 #include <net/cfg80211.h>
23 #include <net/codel.h>
24 #include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h>
25 #include <linux/unaligned.h>
26
27 /**
28 * DOC: Introduction
29 *
30 * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
31 * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
32 * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
33 * drivers.
34 */
35
36 /**
37 * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
38 *
39 * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
40 * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
41 * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
42 * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
43 * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
44 * tasklet function.
45 *
46 * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
47 * use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
48 */
49
50 /**
51 * DOC: Warning
52 *
53 * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
54 * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
55 */
56
57 /**
58 * DOC: Frame format
59 *
60 * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
61 * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
62 * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
63 * hardware.
64 *
65 * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
66 *
67 * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
68 * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
69 *
70 * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
71 * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
72 */
73
74 /**
75 * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
76 *
77 * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
78 * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
79 * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
80 * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
81 *
82 * mac80211 will flush the workqueue upon interface removal and during
83 * suspend.
84 *
85 * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
86 *
87 */
88
89 /**
90 * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing
91 *
92 * mac80211 uses an intermediate queueing implementation, designed to allow the
93 * driver to keep hardware queues short and to provide some fairness between
94 * different stations/interfaces.
95 *
96 * Drivers must provide the .wake_tx_queue driver operation by either
97 * linking it to ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() or implementing a custom
98 * handler.
99 *
100 * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with
101 * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and
102 * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames.
103 *
104 * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations
105 * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops.
106 *
107 * The driver can't access the internal TX queues (iTXQs) directly.
108 * Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue
109 * driver op.
110 * Drivers implementing a custom .wake_tx_queue op can get them by calling
111 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Drivers using ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() will
112 * simply get the individual frames pushed via the .tx driver operation.
113 *
114 * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to
115 * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to
116 * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls
117 * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using
118 * ieee80211_return_txq().
119 *
120 * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has
121 * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling
122 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq
123 * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls
124 * .release_buffered_frames().
125 * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own
126 * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained
127 * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue).
128 */
129
130 /**
131 * DOC: HW timestamping
132 *
133 * Timing Measurement and Fine Timing Measurement require accurate timestamps
134 * of the action frames TX/RX and their respective acks.
135 *
136 * To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine Timing
137 * Measurement frame RX, the low level driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp
138 * field to the frame RX timestamp and report the ack TX timestamp in the
139 * ieee80211_rx_status struct.
140 *
141 * Similarly, to report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine
142 * Timing Measurement frame TX, the driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp field
143 * to the frame TX timestamp and report the ack RX timestamp in the
144 * ieee80211_tx_status struct.
145 */
146 struct device;
147
148 /**
149 * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
150 *
151 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
152 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set
153 */
154 enum ieee80211_max_queues {
155 IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES = 16,
156 IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP = BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1,
157 };
158
159 #define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE 0xff
160
161 /**
162 * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
163 * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
164 * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
165 * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
166 * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
167 */
168 enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
169 IEEE80211_AC_VO = 0,
170 IEEE80211_AC_VI = 1,
171 IEEE80211_AC_BE = 2,
172 IEEE80211_AC_BK = 3,
173 };
174
175 /**
176 * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
177 *
178 * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
179 * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
180 *
181 * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
182 * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
183 * 2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
184 * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
185 * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
186 * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category
187 * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
188 * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured
189 * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE
190 */
191 struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
192 u16 txop;
193 u16 cw_min;
194 u16 cw_max;
195 u8 aifs;
196 bool acm;
197 bool uapsd;
198 bool mu_edca;
199 struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec;
200 };
201
202 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
203 unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
204 unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
205 unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
206 unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
207 };
208
209 /**
210 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context
211 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed
212 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed
213 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed
214 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel,
215 * this is used only with channel switching with CSA
216 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_DEF: The min chandef changed
217 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_AP: The AP channel definition changed, so (wider
218 * bandwidth) OFDMA settings need to be changed
219 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_PUNCTURING: The punctured channel(s) bitmap
220 * was changed.
221 */
222 enum ieee80211_chanctx_change {
223 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH = BIT(0),
224 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS = BIT(1),
225 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR = BIT(2),
226 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL = BIT(3),
227 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_DEF = BIT(4),
228 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_AP = BIT(5),
229 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_PUNCTURING = BIT(6),
230 };
231
232 /**
233 * struct ieee80211_chan_req - A channel "request"
234 * @oper: channel definition to use for operation
235 * @ap: the channel definition of the AP, if any
236 * (otherwise the chan member is %NULL)
237 */
238 struct ieee80211_chan_req {
239 struct cfg80211_chan_def oper;
240 struct cfg80211_chan_def ap;
241 };
242
243 /**
244 * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to
245 *
246 * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx
247 * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only.
248 *
249 * @def: the channel definition
250 * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required.
251 * @ap: the channel definition the AP actually is operating as,
252 * for use with (wider bandwidth) OFDMA
253 * @radio_idx: index of the wiphy radio used used for this channel
254 * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be
255 * active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions
256 * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled
257 * after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions;
258 * this will always be >= @rx_chains_static.
259 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel.
260 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
261 * sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
262 */
263 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf {
264 struct cfg80211_chan_def def;
265 struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def;
266 struct cfg80211_chan_def ap;
267
268 int radio_idx;
269 u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic;
270
271 bool radar_enabled;
272
273 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
274 };
275
276 /**
277 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode
278 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already
279 * exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface
280 * needs to be switched from one to the other.
281 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop
282 * to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but
283 * will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches
284 * from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course
285 * implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing
286 * hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context
287 * will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used
288 * for changes/removal.)
289 */
290 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode {
291 CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF,
292 CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS,
293 };
294
295 /**
296 * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information
297 *
298 * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that
299 * needs to switch from one chanctx to another. The
300 * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be
301 * done.
302 *
303 * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx
304 * @link_conf: the link conf that's switching
305 * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned
306 * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned
307 */
308 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch {
309 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
310 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf;
311 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx;
312 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx;
313 };
314
315 /**
316 * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
317 *
318 * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed(), link_info_changed()
319 * and vif_cfg_changed() callbacks to indicate which parameter(s) changed.
320 *
321 * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
322 * also implies a change in the AID.
323 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
324 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
325 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
326 * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
327 * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
328 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
329 * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
330 * reason (IBSS and managed mode)
331 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
332 * new beacon (beaconing modes)
333 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
334 * enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
335 * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
336 * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
337 * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
338 * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
339 * that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
340 * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
341 * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode)
342 * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode)
343 * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode)
344 * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface
345 * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS)
346 * changed
347 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available:
348 * currently dtim_period only is under consideration.
349 * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed,
350 * note that this is only called when it changes after the channel
351 * context had been assigned.
352 * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed
353 * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed
354 * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected
355 * keep alive) changed.
356 * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface
357 * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder
358 * functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode).
359 * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed
360 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed.
361 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed
362 * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed.
363 * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
364 * status changed.
365 * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS: MLD valid links status changed.
366 * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_TTLM: negotiated TID to link mapping was changed
367 * @BSS_CHANGED_TPE: transmit power envelope changed
368 */
369 enum ieee80211_bss_change {
370 BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC = 1<<0,
371 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT = 1<<1,
372 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE = 1<<2,
373 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT = 1<<3,
374 BSS_CHANGED_HT = 1<<4,
375 BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES = 1<<5,
376 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT = 1<<6,
377 BSS_CHANGED_BSSID = 1<<7,
378 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON = 1<<8,
379 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED = 1<<9,
380 BSS_CHANGED_CQM = 1<<10,
381 BSS_CHANGED_IBSS = 1<<11,
382 BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER = 1<<12,
383 BSS_CHANGED_QOS = 1<<13,
384 BSS_CHANGED_IDLE = 1<<14,
385 BSS_CHANGED_SSID = 1<<15,
386 BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP = 1<<16,
387 BSS_CHANGED_PS = 1<<17,
388 BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER = 1<<18,
389 BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS = 1<<19,
390 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO = 1<<20,
391 BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH = 1<<21,
392 BSS_CHANGED_OCB = 1<<22,
393 BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS = 1<<23,
394 BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE = 1<<24,
395 BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE = 1<<25,
396 BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER = 1<<26,
397 BSS_CHANGED_TWT = 1<<27,
398 BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD = 1<<28,
399 BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR = 1<<29,
400 BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY = 1<<30,
401 BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = BIT_ULL(31),
402 BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS = BIT_ULL(33),
403 BSS_CHANGED_MLD_TTLM = BIT_ULL(34),
404 BSS_CHANGED_TPE = BIT_ULL(35),
405
406 /* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
407 };
408
409 /*
410 * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
411 * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
412 * filtering will be disabled.
413 */
414 #define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
415
416 /**
417 * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver
418 * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver.
419 * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME
420 * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received
421 * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because
422 * they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only
423 * once each time the timeout triggers.
424 */
425 enum ieee80211_event_type {
426 RSSI_EVENT,
427 MLME_EVENT,
428 BAR_RX_EVENT,
429 BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT,
430 };
431
432 /**
433 * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT
434 * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver.
435 * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver.
436 */
437 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data {
438 RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
439 RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
440 };
441
442 /**
443 * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT
444 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data
445 */
446 struct ieee80211_rssi_event {
447 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data;
448 };
449
450 /**
451 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
452 * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication
453 * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association
454 * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received..
455 * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent.
456 */
457 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data {
458 AUTH_EVENT,
459 ASSOC_EVENT,
460 DEAUTH_RX_EVENT,
461 DEAUTH_TX_EVENT,
462 };
463
464 /**
465 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
466 * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully.
467 * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer.
468 * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out.
469 */
470 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status {
471 MLME_SUCCESS,
472 MLME_DENIED,
473 MLME_TIMEOUT,
474 };
475
476 /**
477 * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT
478 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data
479 * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status
480 * @reason: the reason code if applicable
481 */
482 struct ieee80211_mlme_event {
483 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data;
484 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status;
485 u16 reason;
486 };
487
488 /**
489 * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events
490 * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates
491 * @tid: the tid
492 * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT)
493 */
494 struct ieee80211_ba_event {
495 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
496 u16 tid;
497 u16 ssn;
498 };
499
500 /**
501 * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver
502 * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type.
503 * @u.rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT
504 * @u.mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT
505 * @u.ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT
506 * @u:union holding the fields above
507 */
508 struct ieee80211_event {
509 enum ieee80211_event_type type;
510 union {
511 struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi;
512 struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme;
513 struct ieee80211_ba_event ba;
514 } u;
515 };
516
517 /**
518 * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data
519 *
520 * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO
521 *
522 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
523 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
524 */
525 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data {
526 u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN];
527 u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN];
528 };
529
530 /**
531 * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters
532 *
533 * @lci: LCI subelement content
534 * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content
535 * @lci_len: LCI data length
536 * @civicloc_len: Civic data length
537 */
538 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params {
539 const u8 *lci;
540 const u8 *civicloc;
541 size_t lci_len;
542 size_t civicloc_len;
543 };
544
545 /**
546 * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
547 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
548 *
549 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
550 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
551 */
552 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery {
553 u32 min_interval;
554 u32 max_interval;
555 };
556
557 #define IEEE80211_TPE_EIRP_ENTRIES_320MHZ 5
558 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_eirp {
559 bool valid;
560 s8 power[IEEE80211_TPE_EIRP_ENTRIES_320MHZ];
561 u8 count;
562 };
563
564 #define IEEE80211_TPE_PSD_ENTRIES_320MHZ 16
565 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_psd {
566 bool valid;
567 s8 power[IEEE80211_TPE_PSD_ENTRIES_320MHZ];
568 u8 count, n;
569 };
570
571 /**
572 * struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe - parsed transmit power envelope information
573 * @max_local: maximum local EIRP, one value for 20, 40, 80, 160, 320 MHz each
574 * (indexed by TX power category)
575 * @max_reg_client: maximum regulatory client EIRP, one value for 20, 40, 80,
576 * 160, 320 MHz each
577 * (indexed by TX power category)
578 * @psd_local: maximum local power spectral density, one value for each 20 MHz
579 * subchannel per bss_conf's chanreq.oper
580 * (indexed by TX power category)
581 * @psd_reg_client: maximum regulatory power spectral density, one value for
582 * each 20 MHz subchannel per bss_conf's chanreq.oper
583 * (indexed by TX power category)
584 */
585 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe {
586 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_eirp max_local[2], max_reg_client[2];
587 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_psd psd_local[2], psd_reg_client[2];
588 };
589
590 /**
591 * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
592 *
593 * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
594 * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
595 *
596 * @vif: reference to owning VIF
597 * @bss: the cfg80211 bss descriptor. Valid only for a station, and only
598 * when associated. Note: This contains information which is not
599 * necessarily authenticated. For example, information coming from probe
600 * responses.
601 * @addr: (link) address used locally
602 * @link_id: link ID, or 0 for non-MLO
603 * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE
604 * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP
605 * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field
606 * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us
607 * @he_support: does this BSS support HE
608 * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
609 * mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
610 * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
611 * mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
612 * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames
613 * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT
614 * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
615 * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble
616 * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP)
617 * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
618 * valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified
619 * with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then.
620 * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old
621 * as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the
622 * HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can
623 * only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after
624 * association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the
625 * %BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
626 * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf,
627 * the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation
628 * (see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
629 * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY
630 * is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts.
631 * IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync
632 * by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently
633 * guaranteed only in certain callbacks.
634 * Note also that this is not used with MLD associations, mac80211 doesn't
635 * know how to track beacons for all of the links for this.
636 * @beacon_int: beacon interval
637 * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
638 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
639 * index into the rate table configured by the driver in
640 * the current band.
641 * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate
642 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
643 * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
644 * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
645 * @chanreq: Channel request for this BSS -- the hardware might be
646 * configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example.
647 * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data
648 * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation.
649 * This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel.
650 * Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must
651 * be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT.
652 * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
653 * implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should
654 * cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in
655 * relation to the newly configured threshold.
656 * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value
657 * implies disabled. This is an alternative mechanism to the single
658 * threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it.
659 * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold.
660 * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
661 * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
662 * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode.
663 * @txpower: TX power in dBm. INT_MIN means not configured.
664 * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit
665 * Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular
666 * TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is
667 * NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from
668 * userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to
669 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace)
670 * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave
671 * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed
672 * to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS
673 * if it has associated clients without P2P PS support.
674 * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from
675 * transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated.
676 * In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include
677 * a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element.
678 * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN
679 * protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the
680 * station.
681 * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM
682 * responder functionality.
683 * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder.
684 * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile
685 * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP
686 * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set
687 * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set
688 * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of
689 * nontransmitted BSSIDs
690 * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received
691 * in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set.
692 * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are
693 * connected to (STA)
694 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters.
695 * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE
696 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration
697 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
698 * interval.
699 * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed
700 * to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware.
701 * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz
702 * @tpe: transmit power envelope information
703 * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS.
704 * @eht_support: does this BSS support EHT
705 * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on.
706 * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability
707 * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL
708 * when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX
709 * path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always
710 * be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be
711 * processed after it switches back to %NULL.
712 * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing.
713 * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change.
714 * @ht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HT LDPC capability.
715 * @vht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has VHT LDPC capability.
716 * @he_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HE LDPC capability.
717 * @vht_su_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
718 * beamformer
719 * @vht_su_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
720 * beamformee
721 * @vht_mu_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
722 * beamformer
723 * @vht_mu_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
724 * beamformee
725 * @he_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
726 * beamformer
727 * @he_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
728 * beamformee
729 * @he_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE MU
730 * beamformer
731 * @he_full_ul_mumimo: does this BSS support the reception (AP) or transmission
732 * (non-AP STA) of an HE TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
733 * bandwidth
734 * @eht_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
735 * beamformer
736 * @eht_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
737 * beamformee
738 * @eht_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT MU
739 * beamformer
740 * @eht_80mhz_full_bw_ul_mumimo: in AP-mode, does this BSS support the
741 * reception of an EHT TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
742 * bandwidth
743 * @bss_param_ch_cnt: in BSS-mode, the BSS params change count. This
744 * information is the latest known value. It can come from this link's
745 * beacon or from a beacon sent by another link.
746 * @bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id: in BSS-mode, the link_id to which the beacon
747 * that updated &bss_param_ch_cnt belongs. E.g. if link 1 doesn't hear
748 * its beacons, and link 2 sent a beacon with an RNR element that updated
749 * link 1's BSS params change count, then, link 1's
750 * bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id will be 2. That means that link 1 knows that
751 * link 2 was the link that updated its bss_param_ch_cnt value.
752 * In case link 1 hears its beacon again, bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id will
753 * be updated to 1, even if bss_param_ch_cnt didn't change. This allows
754 * the link to know that it heard the latest value from its own beacon
755 * (as opposed to hearing its value from another link's beacon).
756 */
757 struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
758 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
759 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
760
761 const u8 *bssid;
762 unsigned int link_id;
763 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
764 u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext;
765 bool uora_exists;
766 u8 uora_ocw_range;
767 u16 frame_time_rts_th;
768 bool he_support;
769 bool twt_requester;
770 bool twt_responder;
771 bool twt_protected;
772 bool twt_broadcast;
773 /* erp related data */
774 bool use_cts_prot;
775 bool use_short_preamble;
776 bool use_short_slot;
777 bool enable_beacon;
778 u8 dtim_period;
779 u16 beacon_int;
780 u16 assoc_capability;
781 u64 sync_tsf;
782 u32 sync_device_ts;
783 u8 sync_dtim_count;
784 u32 basic_rates;
785 struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate;
786 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
787 u16 ht_operation_mode;
788 s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
789 u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
790 s32 cqm_rssi_low;
791 s32 cqm_rssi_high;
792 struct ieee80211_chan_req chanreq;
793 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group;
794 bool qos;
795 bool hidden_ssid;
796 int txpower;
797 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type;
798 struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr;
799 bool allow_p2p_go_ps;
800 u16 max_idle_period;
801 bool protected_keep_alive;
802 bool ftm_responder;
803 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params;
804 /* Multiple BSSID data */
805 bool nontransmitted;
806 u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
807 u8 bssid_index;
808 u8 bssid_indicator;
809 bool ema_ap;
810 u8 profile_periodicity;
811 struct {
812 u32 params;
813 u16 nss_set;
814 } he_oper;
815 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
816 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
817 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
818 u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval;
819 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate;
820 enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type;
821
822 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe tpe;
823
824 u8 pwr_reduction;
825 bool eht_support;
826
827 bool csa_active;
828
829 bool mu_mimo_owner;
830 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf;
831
832 bool color_change_active;
833 u8 color_change_color;
834
835 bool ht_ldpc;
836 bool vht_ldpc;
837 bool he_ldpc;
838 bool vht_su_beamformer;
839 bool vht_su_beamformee;
840 bool vht_mu_beamformer;
841 bool vht_mu_beamformee;
842 bool he_su_beamformer;
843 bool he_su_beamformee;
844 bool he_mu_beamformer;
845 bool he_full_ul_mumimo;
846 bool eht_su_beamformer;
847 bool eht_su_beamformee;
848 bool eht_mu_beamformer;
849 bool eht_80mhz_full_bw_ul_mumimo;
850 u8 bss_param_ch_cnt;
851 u8 bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id;
852 };
853
854 /**
855 * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
856 *
857 * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
858 *
859 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
860 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
861 * number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
862 * number and increasing the sequence number only when the
863 * IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
864 * assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
865 * for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
866 * that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
867 * If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
868 * assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
869 * 802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
870 * beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
871 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
872 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
873 * station
874 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
875 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
876 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
877 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
878 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
879 * because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
880 * avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
881 * firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
882 * went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
883 * the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
884 * that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
885 * since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
886 * hardware queue.
887 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
888 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
889 * is for the whole aggregation.
890 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
891 * so consider using block ack request (BAR).
892 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
893 * set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
894 * be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
895 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate
896 * that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for
897 * off-channel operation.
898 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation
899 * (header conversion)
900 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
901 * used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
902 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
903 * used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
904 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll
905 * frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must
906 * be sent although the station is in powersave mode.
907 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
908 * transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
909 * by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
910 * queue gets full.
911 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
912 * after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
913 * be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
914 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME
915 * code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status
916 * should kick the MLME state machine.
917 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
918 * MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
919 * status to user space)
920 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
921 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
922 * frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
923 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
924 * the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
925 * in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
926 * handled properly by the device.
927 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
928 * testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
929 * TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
930 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate.
931 * This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P
932 * frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band.
933 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period,
934 * when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in
935 * an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames
936 * the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for
937 * PS-Poll responses.
938 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate.
939 * This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when
940 * the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose.
941 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it
942 * would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for
943 * monitor injection).
944 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with
945 * IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without
946 * any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW).
947 * This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack
948 * behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK.
949 *
950 * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
951 * forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
952 */
953 enum mac80211_tx_info_flags {
954 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS = BIT(0),
955 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ = BIT(1),
956 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK = BIT(2),
957 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT = BIT(3),
958 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT = BIT(4),
959 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM = BIT(5),
960 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU = BIT(6),
961 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED = BIT(7),
962 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED = BIT(8),
963 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK = BIT(9),
964 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU = BIT(10),
965 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK = BIT(11),
966 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE = BIT(12),
967 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK = BIT(13),
968 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP = BIT(14),
969 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED = BIT(15),
970 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT = BIT(16),
971 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER = BIT(17),
972 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES = BIT(18),
973 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION = BIT(19),
974 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX = BIT(20),
975 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX = BIT(21),
976 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC = BIT(22),
977 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC = BIT(23) | BIT(24),
978 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN = BIT(25),
979 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE = BIT(26),
980 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE = BIT(27),
981 IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP = BIT(28),
982 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE = BIT(29),
983 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG = BIT(30),
984 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED = BIT(31),
985 };
986
987 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT 23
988
989 #define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS
990
991 /**
992 * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control
993 *
994 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control
995 * protocol frame (e.g. EAP)
996 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll
997 * frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD).
998 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information
999 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame
1000 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path
1001 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup
1002 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
1003 * used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
1004 * it can be sent out.
1005 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that
1006 * has already been assigned to this frame.
1007 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered
1008 * relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent
1009 * of their QoS TID or other priority field values.
1010 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX: first MLO TX, used mostly internally
1011 * for sequence number assignment
1012 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_USE_RATE_MASK: Don't use rate mask for this frame
1013 * which is transmitted due to scanning or offchannel TX, not in normal
1014 * operation on the interface.
1015 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK: If not @IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, this
1016 * frame should be transmitted on the specific link. This really is
1017 * only relevant for frames that do not have data present, and is
1018 * also not used for 802.3 format frames. Note that even if the frame
1019 * is on a specific link, address translation might still apply if
1020 * it's intended for an MLD.
1021 *
1022 * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags.
1023 */
1024 enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
1025 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO = BIT(0),
1026 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE = BIT(1),
1027 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT = BIT(2),
1028 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU = BIT(3),
1029 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT = BIT(4),
1030 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP = BIT(5),
1031 IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING = BIT(6),
1032 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO = BIT(7),
1033 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER = BIT(8),
1034 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX = BIT(9),
1035 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_USE_RATE_MASK = BIT(10),
1036 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK = 0xf0000000,
1037 };
1038
1039 #define IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED 0xf
1040 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK_UNSPEC \
1041 u32_encode_bits(IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, \
1042 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK)
1043
1044 /**
1045 * enum mac80211_tx_status_flags - flags to describe transmit status
1046 *
1047 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID: ACK signal is valid
1048 *
1049 * These flags are used in tx_info->status.flags.
1050 */
1051 enum mac80211_tx_status_flags {
1052 IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID = BIT(0),
1053 };
1054
1055 /*
1056 * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
1057 * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
1058 */
1059 #define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK | \
1060 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT | \
1061 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU | \
1062 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK | \
1063 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK | \
1064 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER | \
1065 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC | \
1066 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
1067
1068 /**
1069 * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
1070 * Rate Control algorithm.
1071 *
1072 * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
1073 * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
1074 *
1075 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
1076 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
1077 * This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
1078 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
1079 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
1080 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split
1081 * into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number)
1082 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
1083 * Greenfield mode.
1084 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
1085 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission
1086 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission
1087 * (80+80 isn't supported yet)
1088 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
1089 * adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
1090 * NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
1091 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
1092 */
1093 enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
1094 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS = BIT(0),
1095 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT = BIT(1),
1096 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE = BIT(2),
1097
1098 /* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */
1099 IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS = BIT(3),
1100 IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD = BIT(4),
1101 IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(5),
1102 IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA = BIT(6),
1103 IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI = BIT(7),
1104 IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS = BIT(8),
1105 IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(9),
1106 IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(10),
1107 };
1108
1109
1110 /* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
1111 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
1112
1113 /* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
1114 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
1115
1116 /* maximum number of rate stages */
1117 #define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES 4
1118
1119 /* maximum number of rate table entries */
1120 #define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE 4
1121
1122 /**
1123 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
1124 *
1125 * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
1126 * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
1127 * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
1128 *
1129 * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
1130 * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
1131 *
1132 * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
1133 * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
1134 *
1135 * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
1136 * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
1137 * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
1138 * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
1139 * information::
1140 *
1141 * { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
1142 *
1143 * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
1144 * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
1145 * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
1146 * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
1147 * information should then contain::
1148 *
1149 * { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
1150 *
1151 * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
1152 * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
1153 */
1154 struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
1155 s8 idx;
1156 u16 count:5,
1157 flags:11;
1158 } __packed;
1159
1160 #define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY 31
1161
ieee80211_rate_valid(struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1162 static inline bool ieee80211_rate_valid(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1163 {
1164 return rate->idx >= 0 && rate->count > 0;
1165 }
1166
ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate,u8 mcs,u8 nss)1167 static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate,
1168 u8 mcs, u8 nss)
1169 {
1170 WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF);
1171 WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7);
1172 rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs;
1173 }
1174
1175 static inline u8
ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1176 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1177 {
1178 return rate->idx & 0xF;
1179 }
1180
1181 static inline u8
ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1182 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1183 {
1184 return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1;
1185 }
1186
1187 /**
1188 * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
1189 *
1190 * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
1191 * (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
1192 * (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
1193 * (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
1194 *
1195 * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
1196 * @band: the band to transmit on (use e.g. for checking for races),
1197 * not valid if the interface is an MLD since we won't know which
1198 * link the frame will be transmitted on
1199 * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC
1200 * @status_data: internal data for TX status handling, assigned privately,
1201 * see also &enum ieee80211_status_data for the internal documentation
1202 * @status_data_idr: indicates status data is IDR allocated ID for ack frame
1203 * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally
1204 * @control: union part for control data
1205 * @control.rates: TX rates array to try
1206 * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS
1207 * @control.use_rts: use RTS
1208 * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS
1209 * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only)
1210 * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table
1211 * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients
1212 * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL)
1213 * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL)
1214 * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags
1215 * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs)
1216 * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space
1217 * @pad: padding
1218 * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates
1219 * @status: union part for status data
1220 * @status.rates: attempted rates
1221 * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal
1222 * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length
1223 * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length
1224 * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy)
1225 * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only
1226 * used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness
1227 * @status.flags: status flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_status_flags
1228 * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area
1229 * @ack: union part for pure ACK data
1230 * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK
1231 * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
1232 */
1233 struct ieee80211_tx_info {
1234 /* common information */
1235 u32 flags;
1236 u32 band:3,
1237 status_data_idr:1,
1238 status_data:13,
1239 hw_queue:4,
1240 tx_time_est:10;
1241 /* 1 free bit */
1242
1243 union {
1244 struct {
1245 union {
1246 /* rate control */
1247 struct {
1248 struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
1249 IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1250 s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
1251 u8 use_rts:1;
1252 u8 use_cts_prot:1;
1253 u8 short_preamble:1;
1254 u8 skip_table:1;
1255
1256 /* for injection only (bitmap) */
1257 u8 antennas:2;
1258
1259 /* 14 bits free */
1260 };
1261 /* only needed before rate control */
1262 unsigned long jiffies;
1263 };
1264 /* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
1265 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
1266 struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
1267 u32 flags;
1268 codel_time_t enqueue_time;
1269 } control;
1270 struct {
1271 u64 cookie;
1272 } ack;
1273 struct {
1274 struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1275 s32 ack_signal;
1276 u8 ampdu_ack_len;
1277 u8 ampdu_len;
1278 u8 antenna;
1279 u8 pad;
1280 u16 tx_time;
1281 u8 flags;
1282 u8 pad2;
1283 void *status_driver_data[16 / sizeof(void *)];
1284 } status;
1285 struct {
1286 struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
1287 IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1288 u8 pad[4];
1289
1290 void *rate_driver_data[
1291 IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1292 };
1293 void *driver_data[
1294 IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1295 };
1296 };
1297
1298 static inline u16
ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info,u16 tx_time_est)1299 ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est)
1300 {
1301 /* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime
1302 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1
1303 */
1304 info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2;
1305 return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1306 }
1307
1308 static inline u16
ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)1309 ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1310 {
1311 return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1312 }
1313
1314 /***
1315 * struct ieee80211_rate_status - mrr stage for status path
1316 *
1317 * This struct is used in struct ieee80211_tx_status to provide drivers a
1318 * dynamic way to report about used rates and power levels per packet.
1319 *
1320 * @rate_idx The actual used rate.
1321 * @try_count How often the rate was tried.
1322 * @tx_power_idx An idx into the ieee80211_hw->tx_power_levels list of the
1323 * corresponding wifi hardware. The idx shall point to the power level
1324 * that was used when sending the packet.
1325 */
1326 struct ieee80211_rate_status {
1327 struct rate_info rate_idx;
1328 u8 try_count;
1329 u8 tx_power_idx;
1330 };
1331
1332 /**
1333 * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control
1334 *
1335 * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for
1336 * @info: Basic tx status information
1337 * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver)
1338 * @rates: Mrr stages that were used when sending the packet
1339 * @n_rates: Number of mrr stages (count of instances for @rates)
1340 * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver
1341 * @ack_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp of the received ack in nanoseconds
1342 * Only needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action
1343 * frames. Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1344 */
1345 struct ieee80211_tx_status {
1346 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1347 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info;
1348 struct sk_buff *skb;
1349 struct ieee80211_rate_status *rates;
1350 ktime_t ack_hwtstamp;
1351 u8 n_rates;
1352
1353 struct list_head *free_list;
1354 };
1355
1356 /**
1357 * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs
1358 *
1359 * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan
1360 * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace
1361 * and the ones generated by mac80211.
1362 *
1363 * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs.
1364 * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs.
1365 * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones)
1366 * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies
1367 */
1368 struct ieee80211_scan_ies {
1369 const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1370 size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1371 const u8 *common_ies;
1372 size_t common_ie_len;
1373 };
1374
1375
IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff * skb)1376 static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1377 {
1378 return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
1379 }
1380
IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff * skb)1381 static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1382 {
1383 return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
1384 }
1385
1386 /**
1387 * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
1388 *
1389 * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
1390 *
1391 * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
1392 * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
1393 * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
1394 * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
1395 *
1396 * NOTE: While the rates array is kept intact, this will wipe all of the
1397 * driver_data fields in info, so it's up to the driver to restore
1398 * any fields it needs after calling this helper.
1399 */
1400 static inline void
ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)1401 ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1402 {
1403 int i;
1404
1405 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1406 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
1407 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1408 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
1409 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
1410 /* clear the rate counts */
1411 for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
1412 info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
1413 memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates);
1414 }
1415
1416
1417 /**
1418 * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
1419 *
1420 * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
1421 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
1422 * Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
1423 * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
1424 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
1425 * verification has been done by the hardware.
1426 * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame.
1427 * If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
1428 * hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
1429 * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this
1430 * flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection.
1431 * Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame
1432 * is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set)
1433 * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did
1434 * de-duplication by itself.
1435 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
1436 * the frame.
1437 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
1438 * the frame.
1439 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1440 * field) is valid if this field is non-zero, and the position
1441 * where the timestamp was sampled depends on the value.
1442 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1443 * field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
1444 * was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
1445 * merging.
1446 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1447 * field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU
1448 * (including FCS) was received.
1449 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1450 * field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received.
1451 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64: The timestamp passed in the RX status @mactime
1452 * is only for use in the radiotap timestamp header, not otherwise a valid
1453 * @mactime value. Note this is a separate flag so that we continue to see
1454 * %RX_FLAG_MACTIME as unset. Also note that in this case the timestamp is
1455 * reported to be 64 bits wide, not just 32.
1456 * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present.
1457 * Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU)
1458 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference
1459 * number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for
1460 * each A-MPDU
1461 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all
1462 * subframes of a single A-MPDU
1463 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU
1464 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected
1465 * on this subframe
1466 * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was
1467 * done by the hardware
1468 * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without
1469 * processing it in any regular way.
1470 * This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1471 * them for sniffing purposes.
1472 * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except
1473 * monitor interfaces.
1474 * This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1475 * them for sniffing purposes.
1476 * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU
1477 * subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons.
1478 * All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g.
1479 * if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while
1480 * the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to
1481 * deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU
1482 * subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be
1483 * either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be
1484 * interleaved with other frames.
1485 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END: This frame contains radiotap TLVs in the
1486 * skb->data (before the 802.11 header).
1487 * If used, the SKB's mac_header pointer must be set to point
1488 * to the 802.11 header after the TLVs, and any padding added after TLV
1489 * data to align to 4 must be cleared by the driver putting the TLVs
1490 * in the skb.
1491 * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before.
1492 * This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as
1493 * the first subframe.
1494 * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must
1495 * be done in the hardware.
1496 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this
1497 * frame
1498 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known
1499 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present
1500 * (&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in
1501 *
1502 * - DATA3_DATA_MCS
1503 * - DATA3_DATA_DCM
1504 * - DATA3_CODING
1505 * - DATA5_GI
1506 * - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC
1507 * - DATA6_NSTS
1508 * - DATA3_STBC
1509 *
1510 * from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data)
1511 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present
1512 * (&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu)
1513 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present
1514 * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with
1515 * the "0-length PSDU" field included there. The value for it is
1516 * in &struct ieee80211_rx_status. Note that if this value isn't
1517 * known the frame shouldn't be reported.
1518 * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by
1519 * hardware or driver)
1520 */
1521 enum mac80211_rx_flags {
1522 RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR = BIT(0),
1523 RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED = BIT(1),
1524 RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR = BIT(2),
1525 RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED = BIT(3),
1526 RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED = BIT(4),
1527 RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC = BIT(5),
1528 RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC = BIT(6),
1529 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64 = BIT(7),
1530 RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL = BIT(8),
1531 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS = BIT(9),
1532 RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED = BIT(10),
1533 RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED = BIT(11),
1534 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN = BIT(12),
1535 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST = BIT(13),
1536 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR = BIT(14),
1537 /* one free bit at 15 */
1538 RX_FLAG_MACTIME = BIT(16) | BIT(17),
1539 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START = 1 << 16,
1540 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START = 2 << 16,
1541 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END = 3 << 16,
1542 RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR = BIT(18),
1543 RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE = BIT(19),
1544 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END = BIT(20),
1545 RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED = BIT(21),
1546 RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN = BIT(22),
1547 RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED = BIT(23),
1548 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT = BIT(24),
1549 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN = BIT(25),
1550 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE = BIT(26),
1551 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU = BIT(27),
1552 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG = BIT(28),
1553 RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU = BIT(29),
1554 RX_FLAG_8023 = BIT(30),
1555 };
1556
1557 /**
1558 * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags
1559 *
1560 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
1561 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
1562 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission,
1563 * if the driver fills this value it should add
1564 * %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT
1565 * to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact.
1566 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used
1567 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3
1568 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed
1569 */
1570 enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags {
1571 RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE = BIT(0),
1572 RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI = BIT(2),
1573 RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF = BIT(3),
1574 RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK = BIT(4) | BIT(5),
1575 RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC = BIT(6),
1576 RX_ENC_FLAG_BF = BIT(7),
1577 };
1578
1579 #define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT 4
1580
1581 enum mac80211_rx_encoding {
1582 RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0,
1583 RX_ENC_HT,
1584 RX_ENC_VHT,
1585 RX_ENC_HE,
1586 RX_ENC_EHT,
1587 };
1588
1589 /**
1590 * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
1591 *
1592 * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
1593 * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
1594 * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
1595 *
1596 * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
1597 * (TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
1598 * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is
1599 * needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache.
1600 * @ack_tx_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp for the ack TX in nanoseconds. Only
1601 * needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action frames.
1602 * Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1603 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use
1604 * it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation
1605 * @band: the active band when this frame was received
1606 * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
1607 * This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed
1608 * for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting.
1609 * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz.
1610 * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
1611 * unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
1612 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
1613 * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength
1614 * values were filled.
1615 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't
1616 * support dB or unspecified units)
1617 * @antenna: antenna used
1618 * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
1619 * HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT)
1620 * @nss: number of streams (VHT, HE and EHT only)
1621 * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\*
1622 * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding
1623 * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw
1624 * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags
1625 * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc
1626 * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi
1627 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1628 * @eht: EHT specific rate information
1629 * @eht.ru: EHT RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc
1630 * @eht.gi: EHT GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi
1631 * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
1632 * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for
1633 * each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU
1634 * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU
1635 * @link_valid: if the link which is identified by @link_id is valid. This flag
1636 * is set only when connection is MLO.
1637 * @link_id: id of the link used to receive the packet. This is used along with
1638 * @link_valid.
1639 */
1640 struct ieee80211_rx_status {
1641 u64 mactime;
1642 union {
1643 u64 boottime_ns;
1644 ktime_t ack_tx_hwtstamp;
1645 };
1646 u32 device_timestamp;
1647 u32 ampdu_reference;
1648 u32 flag;
1649 u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1;
1650 u8 enc_flags;
1651 u8 encoding:3, bw:4;
1652 union {
1653 struct {
1654 u8 he_ru:3;
1655 u8 he_gi:2;
1656 u8 he_dcm:1;
1657 };
1658 struct {
1659 u8 ru:4;
1660 u8 gi:2;
1661 } eht;
1662 };
1663 u8 rate_idx;
1664 u8 nss;
1665 u8 rx_flags;
1666 u8 band;
1667 u8 antenna;
1668 s8 signal;
1669 u8 chains;
1670 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1671 u8 zero_length_psdu_type;
1672 u8 link_valid:1, link_id:4;
1673 };
1674
1675 static inline u32
ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status * rx_status)1676 ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status)
1677 {
1678 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) +
1679 (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0);
1680 }
1681
1682 /**
1683 * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
1684 *
1685 * Flags to define PHY configuration options
1686 *
1687 * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
1688 * to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
1689 * or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
1690 * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
1691 * This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
1692 * meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
1693 * transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
1694 * Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
1695 * driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
1696 * for more.
1697 * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
1698 * the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
1699 * may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
1700 * be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
1701 * it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
1702 * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
1703 * operating channel.
1704 */
1705 enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
1706 IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR = (1<<0),
1707 IEEE80211_CONF_PS = (1<<1),
1708 IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE = (1<<2),
1709 IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL = (1<<3),
1710 };
1711
1712
1713 /**
1714 * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
1715 *
1716 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
1717 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
1718 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
1719 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
1720 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
1721 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
1722 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
1723 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
1724 * Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1725 * otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1726 */
1727 enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
1728 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS = BIT(1),
1729 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL = BIT(2),
1730 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR = BIT(3),
1731 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS = BIT(4),
1732 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER = BIT(5),
1733 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL = BIT(6),
1734 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS = BIT(7),
1735 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE = BIT(8),
1736 };
1737
1738 /**
1739 * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
1740 *
1741 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
1742 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
1743 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
1744 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
1745 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
1746 */
1747 enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
1748 IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
1749 IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
1750 IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
1751 IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
1752
1753 /* keep last */
1754 IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
1755 };
1756
1757 /**
1758 * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
1759 *
1760 * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
1761 *
1762 * @flags: configuration flags defined above
1763 *
1764 * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
1765 * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
1766 * in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
1767 * has been received and the DTIM period is known.
1768 * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
1769 * powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
1770 * the CONF_PS flag is set.
1771 *
1772 * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility
1773 * value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces
1774 *
1775 * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to
1776 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled
1777 *
1778 * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
1779 * (a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
1780 * but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
1781 * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
1782 * frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
1783 * number of transmissions not the number of retries
1784 *
1785 * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
1786 * %IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
1787 * configured for an HT channel.
1788 * Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1789 * otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1790 */
1791 struct ieee80211_conf {
1792 u32 flags;
1793 int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
1794
1795 u16 listen_interval;
1796 u8 ps_dtim_period;
1797
1798 u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
1799
1800 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1801 bool radar_enabled;
1802 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1803 };
1804
1805 /**
1806 * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
1807 *
1808 * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
1809 * operation.
1810 *
1811 * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
1812 * Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
1813 * announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
1814 * the driver passed into mac80211.
1815 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the
1816 * rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211.
1817 * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
1818 * scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
1819 * @chandef: the new channel to switch to
1820 * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
1821 * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in
1822 * current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new
1823 * channel, expressed in TU.
1824 * @link_id: the link ID of the link doing the channel switch, 0 for non-MLO
1825 */
1826 struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
1827 u64 timestamp;
1828 u32 device_timestamp;
1829 bool block_tx;
1830 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1831 u8 count;
1832 u8 link_id;
1833 u32 delay;
1834 };
1835
1836 /**
1837 * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags
1838 *
1839 * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering
1840 * on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups
1841 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality
1842 * monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor
1843 * connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1844 * provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1845 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this
1846 * interface. This flag should be set during interface addition,
1847 * but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is
1848 * only valid for managed/station mode interfaces.
1849 * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes
1850 * and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even
1851 * this is not pure P2P vif.
1852 * @IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE: The driver indicates that EML operation is
1853 * enabled for the interface.
1854 * @IEEE80211_VIF_IGNORE_OFDMA_WIDER_BW: Ignore wider bandwidth OFDMA
1855 * operation on this interface and request a channel context without
1856 * the AP definition. Use this e.g. because the device is able to
1857 * handle OFDMA (downlink and trigger for uplink) on a per-AP basis.
1858 * @IEEE80211_VIF_REMOVE_AP_AFTER_DISASSOC: indicates that the AP sta should
1859 * be removed only after setting the vif as unassociated, and not the
1860 * opposite. Only relevant for STA vifs.
1861 */
1862 enum ieee80211_vif_flags {
1863 IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER = BIT(0),
1864 IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI = BIT(1),
1865 IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD = BIT(2),
1866 IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE = BIT(3),
1867 IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE = BIT(4),
1868 IEEE80211_VIF_IGNORE_OFDMA_WIDER_BW = BIT(5),
1869 IEEE80211_VIF_REMOVE_AP_AFTER_DISASSOC = BIT(6),
1870 };
1871
1872
1873 /**
1874 * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags
1875 *
1876 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled
1877 * The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211.
1878 * It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface.
1879 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload
1880 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled
1881 * The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to
1882 * mac80211.
1883 */
1884
1885 enum ieee80211_offload_flags {
1886 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED = BIT(0),
1887 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR = BIT(1),
1888 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED = BIT(2),
1889 };
1890
1891 /**
1892 * struct ieee80211_vif_cfg - interface configuration
1893 * @assoc: association status
1894 * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS or not
1895 * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created
1896 * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by
1897 * offchannel/dynamic_ps operations.
1898 * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
1899 * @eml_cap: EML capabilities as described in P802.11be_D4.1 Figure 9-1001j.
1900 * @eml_med_sync_delay: Medium Synchronization delay as described in
1901 * P802.11be_D4.1 Figure 9-1001i.
1902 * @mld_capa_op: MLD Capabilities and Operations per P802.11be_D4.1
1903 * Figure 9-1001k
1904 * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
1905 * may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
1906 * The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
1907 * to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
1908 * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this
1909 * may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list
1910 * array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case.
1911 * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode.
1912 * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid.
1913 * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format).
1914 * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
1915 * hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
1916 * your driver/device needs to do.
1917 * @ap_addr: AP MLD address, or BSSID for non-MLO connections
1918 * (station mode only)
1919 */
1920 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg {
1921 /* association related data */
1922 bool assoc, ibss_joined;
1923 bool ibss_creator;
1924 bool ps;
1925 u16 aid;
1926 u16 eml_cap;
1927 u16 eml_med_sync_delay;
1928 u16 mld_capa_op;
1929
1930 __be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
1931 int arp_addr_cnt;
1932 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
1933 size_t ssid_len;
1934 bool s1g;
1935 bool idle;
1936 u8 ap_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1937 };
1938
1939 #define IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS 8
1940
1941 /**
1942 * struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm - negotiated TID to link map info
1943 *
1944 * @downlink: bitmap of active links per TID for downlink, or 0 if mapping for
1945 * this TID is not included.
1946 * @uplink: bitmap of active links per TID for uplink, or 0 if mapping for this
1947 * TID is not included.
1948 * @valid: info is valid or not.
1949 */
1950 struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm {
1951 u16 downlink[IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS];
1952 u16 uplink[IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS];
1953 bool valid;
1954 };
1955
1956 /**
1957 * enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res - return value for negotiated TTLM handling
1958 * @NEG_TTLM_RES_ACCEPT: accept the request
1959 * @NEG_TTLM_RES_REJECT: reject the request
1960 * @NEG_TTLM_RES_SUGGEST_PREFERRED: reject and suggest a new mapping
1961 */
1962 enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res {
1963 NEG_TTLM_RES_ACCEPT,
1964 NEG_TTLM_RES_REJECT,
1965 NEG_TTLM_RES_SUGGEST_PREFERRED
1966 };
1967
1968 /**
1969 * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
1970 *
1971 * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
1972 * use during the life of a virtual interface.
1973 *
1974 * @type: type of this virtual interface
1975 * @cfg: vif configuration, see &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg
1976 * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
1977 * or the BSS we're associated to
1978 * @link_conf: in case of MLD, the per-link BSS configuration,
1979 * indexed by link ID
1980 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1981 * @active_links: The bitmap of active links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1982 * The driver shouldn't change this directly, but use the
1983 * API calls meant for that purpose.
1984 * @dormant_links: subset of the valid links that are disabled/suspended
1985 * due to advertised or negotiated TTLM respectively.
1986 * 0 for non-MLO.
1987 * @suspended_links: subset of dormant_links representing links that are
1988 * suspended due to negotiated TTLM, and could be activated in the
1989 * future by tearing down the TTLM negotiation.
1990 * 0 for non-MLO.
1991 * @neg_ttlm: negotiated TID to link mapping info.
1992 * see &struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm.
1993 * @addr: address of this interface
1994 * @addr_valid: indicates if the address is actively used. Set to false for
1995 * passive monitor interfaces, true in all other cases.
1996 * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
1997 * interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
1998 * @netdev_features: tx netdev features supported by the hardware for this
1999 * vif. mac80211 initializes this to hw->netdev_features, and the driver
2000 * can mask out specific tx features. mac80211 will handle software fixup
2001 * for masked offloads (GSO, CSUM)
2002 * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface,
2003 * these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added
2004 * or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed
2005 * at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field
2006 * @offload_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface.
2007 * These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface,
2008 * .change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver
2009 * within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change
2010 * restrictions.
2011 * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC
2012 * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only
2013 * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per
2014 * interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual
2015 * monitor interface (if that is requested.)
2016 * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this
2017 * interface.
2018 * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211
2019 * for this interface.
2020 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2021 * sizeof(void \*).
2022 * @txq: the multicast data TX queue
2023 * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see
2024 * &enum ieee80211_offload_flags.
2025 * @mbssid_tx_vif: Pointer to the transmitting interface if MBSSID is enabled.
2026 */
2027 struct ieee80211_vif {
2028 enum nl80211_iftype type;
2029 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg cfg;
2030 struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
2031 struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *link_conf[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2032 u16 valid_links, active_links, dormant_links, suspended_links;
2033 struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm neg_ttlm;
2034 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2035 bool addr_valid;
2036 bool p2p;
2037
2038 u8 cab_queue;
2039 u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
2040
2041 struct ieee80211_txq *txq;
2042
2043 netdev_features_t netdev_features;
2044 u32 driver_flags;
2045 u32 offload_flags;
2046
2047 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
2048 struct dentry *debugfs_dir;
2049 #endif
2050
2051 bool probe_req_reg;
2052 bool rx_mcast_action_reg;
2053
2054 struct ieee80211_vif *mbssid_tx_vif;
2055
2056 /* must be last */
2057 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2058 };
2059
2060 /**
2061 * ieee80211_vif_usable_links - Return the usable links for the vif
2062 * @vif: the vif for which the usable links are requested
2063 * Return: the usable link bitmap
2064 */
ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2065 static inline u16 ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2066 {
2067 return vif->valid_links & ~vif->dormant_links;
2068 }
2069
2070 /**
2071 * ieee80211_vif_is_mld - Returns true iff the vif is an MLD one
2072 * @vif: the vif
2073 * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD, %false otherwise.
2074 */
ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2075 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2076 {
2077 /* valid_links != 0 indicates this vif is an MLD */
2078 return vif->valid_links != 0;
2079 }
2080
2081 /**
2082 * ieee80211_vif_link_active - check if a given link is active
2083 * @vif: the vif
2084 * @link_id: the link ID to check
2085 * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD and the link is active, or if
2086 * the vif is not an MLD and the link ID is 0; %false otherwise.
2087 */
ieee80211_vif_link_active(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif,unsigned int link_id)2088 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_link_active(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
2089 unsigned int link_id)
2090 {
2091 if (!ieee80211_vif_is_mld(vif))
2092 return link_id == 0;
2093 return vif->active_links & BIT(link_id);
2094 }
2095
2096 #define for_each_vif_active_link(vif, link, link_id) \
2097 for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((vif)->link_conf); link_id++) \
2098 if ((!(vif)->active_links || \
2099 (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) && \
2100 (link = link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)))
2101
ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2102 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2103 {
2104 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
2105 return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
2106 #endif
2107 return false;
2108 }
2109
2110 /**
2111 * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev
2112 * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for
2113 *
2114 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
2115 * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev.
2116 *
2117 * Return: pointer to the wdev, or %NULL if the given wdev isn't
2118 * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
2119 * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
2120 */
2121 struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
2122
2123 /**
2124 * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif
2125 * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for
2126 *
2127 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
2128 * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif.
2129 * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif.
2130 *
2131 * Return: pointer to the wdev
2132 */
2133 struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
2134
lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2135 static inline bool lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2136 {
2137 return lockdep_is_held(&ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(vif)->wiphy->mtx);
2138 }
2139
2140 #define link_conf_dereference_protected(vif, link_id) \
2141 rcu_dereference_protected((vif)->link_conf[link_id], \
2142 lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))
2143
2144 #define link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id) \
2145 rcu_dereference_check((vif)->link_conf[link_id], \
2146 lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))
2147
2148 /**
2149 * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
2150 *
2151 * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
2152 * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
2153 *
2154 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
2155 * driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
2156 * particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs
2157 * will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC.
2158 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
2159 * the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
2160 * generation in software.
2161 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
2162 * that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
2163 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a
2164 * CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames
2165 * (MFP) to be done in software.
2166 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver
2167 * if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV
2168 * itself should not be generated. Do not set together with
2169 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does
2170 * not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or
2171 * MIC.
2172 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received
2173 * management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware
2174 * crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames
2175 * properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and
2176 * fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with
2177 * RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the
2178 * %IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW.
2179 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the
2180 * driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation
2181 * only for management frames (MFP).
2182 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the
2183 * driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always
2184 * be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled.
2185 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for
2186 * a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with
2187 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key.
2188 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation.
2189 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver
2190 * for a AES_CMAC or a AES_GMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence
2191 * number generation only
2192 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU: SPP A-MSDUs can be used with this key
2193 * (set by mac80211 from the sta->spp_amsdu flag)
2194 */
2195 enum ieee80211_key_flags {
2196 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT = BIT(0),
2197 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV = BIT(1),
2198 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC = BIT(2),
2199 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE = BIT(3),
2200 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX = BIT(4),
2201 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE = BIT(5),
2202 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT = BIT(6),
2203 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM = BIT(7),
2204 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE = BIT(8),
2205 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX = BIT(9),
2206 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE = BIT(10),
2207 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU = BIT(11),
2208 };
2209
2210 /**
2211 * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
2212 *
2213 * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
2214 * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
2215 *
2216 * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
2217 * wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
2218 * encrypted in hardware.
2219 * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
2220 * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it
2221 * needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO)
2222 * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
2223 * @keyidx: the key index (0-7)
2224 * @keylen: key material length
2225 * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
2226 * data block:
2227 * - Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
2228 * - Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
2229 * - Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
2230 * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
2231 * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
2232 * @link_id: the link ID, 0 for non-MLO, or -1 for pairwise keys
2233 */
2234 struct ieee80211_key_conf {
2235 atomic64_t tx_pn;
2236 u32 cipher;
2237 u8 icv_len;
2238 u8 iv_len;
2239 u8 hw_key_idx;
2240 s8 keyidx;
2241 u16 flags;
2242 s8 link_id;
2243 u8 keylen;
2244 u8 key[];
2245 };
2246
2247 #define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN 16
2248
2249 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff))
2250 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff))
2251
2252 /**
2253 * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
2254 *
2255 * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
2256 * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2257 * reverse order than in packet)
2258 * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2259 * reverse order than in packet)
2260 * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2261 * reverse order than in packet)
2262 * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2263 * reverse order than in packet)
2264 * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys
2265 */
2266 struct ieee80211_key_seq {
2267 union {
2268 struct {
2269 u32 iv32;
2270 u16 iv16;
2271 } tkip;
2272 struct {
2273 u8 pn[6];
2274 } ccmp;
2275 struct {
2276 u8 pn[6];
2277 } aes_cmac;
2278 struct {
2279 u8 pn[6];
2280 } aes_gmac;
2281 struct {
2282 u8 pn[6];
2283 } gcmp;
2284 struct {
2285 u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN];
2286 u8 seq_len;
2287 } hw;
2288 };
2289 };
2290
2291 /**
2292 * enum set_key_cmd - key command
2293 *
2294 * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2295 * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
2296 *
2297 * @SET_KEY: a key is set
2298 * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
2299 */
2300 enum set_key_cmd {
2301 SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
2302 };
2303
2304 /**
2305 * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state
2306 *
2307 * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all,
2308 * this is a special state for add/remove transitions
2309 * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state
2310 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated
2311 * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated
2312 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
2313 */
2314 enum ieee80211_sta_state {
2315 /* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */
2316 IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST,
2317 IEEE80211_STA_NONE,
2318 IEEE80211_STA_AUTH,
2319 IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC,
2320 IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED,
2321 };
2322
2323 /**
2324 * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth
2325 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz
2326 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz
2327 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz
2328 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz
2329 * (including 80+80 MHz)
2330 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320: station can receive up to 320 MHz
2331 *
2332 * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized
2333 * correctly, the values must be sorted.
2334 */
2335 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth {
2336 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0,
2337 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40,
2338 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80,
2339 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160,
2340 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320,
2341 };
2342
2343 #define IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_MAX IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320
2344
2345 /**
2346 * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table
2347 *
2348 * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update
2349 * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default.
2350 * Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control.
2351 */
2352 struct ieee80211_sta_rates {
2353 struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2354 struct {
2355 s8 idx;
2356 u8 count;
2357 u8 count_cts;
2358 u8 count_rts;
2359 u16 flags;
2360 } rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE];
2361 };
2362
2363 /**
2364 * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
2365 *
2366 * Used to configure txpower for station.
2367 *
2368 * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames
2369 * to the STA.
2370 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
2371 * will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
2372 * %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
2373 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
2374 * per peer TPC.
2375 */
2376 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr {
2377 s16 power;
2378 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
2379 };
2380
2381 /**
2382 * struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates - info that is aggregated from active links
2383 *
2384 * Used for any per-link data that needs to be aggregated and updated in the
2385 * main &struct ieee80211_sta when updated or the active links change.
2386 *
2387 * @max_amsdu_len: indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes.
2388 * This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble.
2389 * For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply:
2390 *
2391 * * If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the
2392 * A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes.
2393 * * If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal
2394 * size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes.
2395 *
2396 * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level
2397 * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section
2398 * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2).
2399 * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control.
2400 * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID
2401 */
2402 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates {
2403 u16 max_amsdu_len;
2404
2405 u16 max_rc_amsdu_len;
2406 u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS];
2407 };
2408
2409 /**
2410 * struct ieee80211_link_sta - station Link specific info
2411 * All link specific info for a STA link for a non MLD STA(single)
2412 * or a MLD STA(multiple entries) are stored here.
2413 *
2414 * @sta: reference to owning STA
2415 * @addr: MAC address of the Link STA. For non-MLO STA this is same as the addr
2416 * in ieee80211_sta. For MLO Link STA this addr can be same or different
2417 * from addr in ieee80211_sta (representing MLD STA addr)
2418 * @link_id: the link ID for this link STA (0 for deflink)
2419 * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic)
2420 * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates
2421 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2422 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2423 * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA
2424 * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities
2425 * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities of this STA
2426 * @agg: per-link data for multi-link aggregation
2427 * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with
2428 * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the
2429 * station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode
2430 * notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after
2431 * the station moves to associated state.
2432 * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration
2433 *
2434 */
2435 struct ieee80211_link_sta {
2436 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2437
2438 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2439 u8 link_id;
2440 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
2441
2442 u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2443 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
2444 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
2445 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
2446 struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
2447 struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
2448
2449 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates agg;
2450
2451 u8 rx_nss;
2452 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth;
2453 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr;
2454 };
2455
2456 /**
2457 * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
2458 *
2459 * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
2460 * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
2461 * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
2462 * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
2463 * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
2464 * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
2465 * This also represents the MLD STA in case of MLO association
2466 * and holds pointers to various link STA's
2467 *
2468 * @addr: MAC address
2469 * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
2470 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU
2471 * that this station is allowed to transmit to us.
2472 * Can be modified by driver.
2473 * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does,
2474 * otherwise always false)
2475 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2476 * sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information.
2477 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid
2478 * if wme is supported. The bits order is like in
2479 * IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*.
2480 * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported.
2481 * @rates: rate control selection table
2482 * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer
2483 * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only
2484 * valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place.
2485 * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not.
2486 * @mlo: indicates whether the STA is MLO station.
2487 * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single
2488 * A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means
2489 * unlimited.
2490 * @cur: currently valid data as aggregated from the active links
2491 * For non MLO STA it will point to the deflink data. For MLO STA
2492 * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates() must be called to update it.
2493 * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not.
2494 * @txq: per-TID data TX queues; note that the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)
2495 * is used for non-data frames
2496 * @deflink: This holds the default link STA information, for non MLO STA all link
2497 * specific STA information is accessed through @deflink or through
2498 * link[0] which points to address of @deflink. For MLO Link STA
2499 * the first added link STA will point to deflink.
2500 * @link: reference to Link Sta entries. For Non MLO STA, except 1st link,
2501 * i.e link[0] all links would be assigned to NULL by default and
2502 * would access link information via @deflink or link[0]. For MLO
2503 * STA, first link STA being added will point its link pointer to
2504 * @deflink address and remaining would be allocated and the address
2505 * would be assigned to link[link_id] where link_id is the id assigned
2506 * by the AP.
2507 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO
2508 * @spp_amsdu: indicates whether the STA uses SPP A-MSDU or not.
2509 */
2510 struct ieee80211_sta {
2511 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2512 u16 aid;
2513 u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2514 bool wme;
2515 u8 uapsd_queues;
2516 u8 max_sp;
2517 struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates;
2518 bool tdls;
2519 bool tdls_initiator;
2520 bool mfp;
2521 bool mlo;
2522 bool spp_amsdu;
2523 u8 max_amsdu_subframes;
2524
2525 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates *cur;
2526
2527 bool support_p2p_ps;
2528
2529 struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1];
2530
2531 u16 valid_links;
2532 struct ieee80211_link_sta deflink;
2533 struct ieee80211_link_sta __rcu *link[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2534
2535 /* must be last */
2536 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2537 };
2538
2539 #ifdef CONFIG_LOCKDEP
2540 bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
2541 #else
lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta * pubsta)2542 static inline bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta)
2543 {
2544 return true;
2545 }
2546 #endif
2547
2548 #define link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id) \
2549 rcu_dereference_protected((sta)->link[link_id], \
2550 lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2551
2552 #define link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id) \
2553 rcu_dereference_check((sta)->link[link_id], \
2554 lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2555
2556 #define for_each_sta_active_link(vif, sta, link_sta, link_id) \
2557 for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((sta)->link); link_id++) \
2558 if ((!(vif)->active_links || \
2559 (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) && \
2560 ((link_sta) = link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)))
2561
2562 /**
2563 * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
2564 *
2565 * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2566 * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
2567 *
2568 * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
2569 * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
2570 */
2571 enum sta_notify_cmd {
2572 STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
2573 };
2574
2575 /**
2576 * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data
2577 *
2578 * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and
2579 * it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU.
2580 */
2581 struct ieee80211_tx_control {
2582 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2583 };
2584
2585 /**
2586 * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue
2587 *
2588 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2589 * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue
2590 * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue),
2591 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled)
2592 * @ac: the AC for this queue
2593 * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size
2594 *
2595 * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling
2596 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue().
2597 */
2598 struct ieee80211_txq {
2599 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
2600 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2601 u8 tid;
2602 u8 ac;
2603
2604 /* must be last */
2605 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2606 };
2607
2608 /**
2609 * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
2610 *
2611 * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
2612 * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
2613 * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
2614 * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
2615 * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
2616 *
2617 * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
2618 * The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
2619 * controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
2620 * should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
2621 * will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
2622 * algorithm.
2623 * Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
2624 * callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
2625 * the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
2626 * @use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
2627 * timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
2628 * CCK frames.
2629 *
2630 * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
2631 * Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
2632 * the FCS at the end.
2633 *
2634 * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
2635 * Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
2636 * for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
2637 * rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
2638 * to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
2639 * multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
2640 * the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
2641 *
2642 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
2643 * Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
2644 * expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
2645 * If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
2646 *
2647 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
2648 * Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
2649 * one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
2650 * between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
2651 *
2652 * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
2653 * Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
2654 * Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
2655 *
2656 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
2657 * Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
2658 *
2659 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
2660 * Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
2661 *
2662 * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
2663 * Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
2664 * stack support for dynamic PS.
2665 *
2666 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
2667 * Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
2668 *
2669 * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
2670 * Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
2671 *
2672 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
2673 * Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
2674 * the stack.
2675 *
2676 * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
2677 * The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
2678 * periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
2679 *
2680 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC:
2681 * This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e.
2682 * dtim_period).
2683 *
2684 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
2685 * per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
2686 * the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
2687 * to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
2688 * possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
2689 * only in that case.
2690 *
2691 * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
2692 * autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
2693 * this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
2694 * stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
2695 * Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
2696 * the PS mode of connected stations.
2697 *
2698 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session
2699 * setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in
2700 * software.
2701 *
2702 * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of
2703 * a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only
2704 * active interfaces.
2705 *
2706 * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_VIRTUAL_MONITOR: The driver would like to be informed
2707 * of any monitor interface, as well as their configured channel.
2708 * This is useful for supporting multiple monitor interfaces on different
2709 * channels.
2710 *
2711 * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to
2712 * be created. It is expected user-space will create vifs as
2713 * desired (and thus have them named as desired).
2714 *
2715 * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the
2716 * crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically
2717 * try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if
2718 * the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its
2719 * supported cipher suites.
2720 *
2721 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit,
2722 * this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration
2723 * for frames.
2724 *
2725 * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface
2726 * queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC)
2727 * for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue
2728 * control for more details.
2729 *
2730 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate
2731 * selection table provided by the rate control algorithm.
2732 *
2733 * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any
2734 * P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface
2735 * is supported.
2736 *
2737 * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames
2738 * only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon.
2739 *
2740 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates
2741 * and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not
2742 * using aggregation for such frames.)
2743 *
2744 * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA)
2745 * for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support
2746 * is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the
2747 * CSA frame.
2748 *
2749 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload
2750 * or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first.
2751 *
2752 * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands
2753 * in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band.
2754 *
2755 * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth
2756 * than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel.
2757 *
2758 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs
2759 * within A-MPDU.
2760 *
2761 * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status
2762 * for sent beacons.
2763 *
2764 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each
2765 * station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified
2766 * by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station
2767 * from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time.
2768 *
2769 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the
2770 * reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in
2771 * order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session
2772 * timeout.
2773 *
2774 * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX,
2775 * which implies using per-CPU station statistics.
2776 *
2777 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated
2778 * A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support.
2779 * When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must
2780 * limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting
2781 * max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta.
2782 *
2783 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list
2784 * skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU.
2785 *
2786 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event
2787 * by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such
2788 * drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver
2789 * is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout.
2790 *
2791 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself.
2792 * The stack will not do fragmentation.
2793 * The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well.
2794 *
2795 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on
2796 * TDLS links.
2797 *
2798 * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't
2799 * support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug.
2800 *
2801 * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of
2802 * course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with.
2803 *
2804 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT
2805 * extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if
2806 * the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW
2807 * but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver.
2808 * See also the documentation for that flag.
2809 *
2810 * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all
2811 * MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use
2812 * TXQs to start with.
2813 *
2814 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU
2815 * length in tx status information
2816 *
2817 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2818 *
2819 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2820 * only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set.
2821 *
2822 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only
2823 * aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx
2824 * A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID.
2825 *
2826 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation
2827 * offload
2828 *
2829 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation
2830 * offload
2831 *
2832 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx
2833 * decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface.
2834 * If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real
2835 * usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to
2836 * the stack.
2837 *
2838 * @IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION: HW/driver has support for BSS color
2839 * collision detection and doesn't need it in software.
2840 *
2841 * @IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX: Hardware/driver handles transmitting
2842 * multicast frames on all links, mac80211 should not do that.
2843 *
2844 * @IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING: HW requires disabling puncturing in EHT
2845 * and connecting with a lower bandwidth instead
2846 * @IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING_5GHZ: HW requires disabling puncturing in
2847 * EHT in 5 GHz and connecting with a lower bandwidth instead
2848 *
2849 * @IEEE80211_HW_HANDLES_QUIET_CSA: HW/driver handles quieting for CSA, so
2850 * no need to stop queues. This really should be set by a driver that
2851 * implements MLO, so operation can continue on other links when one
2852 * link is switching.
2853 *
2854 * @IEEE80211_HW_STRICT: strictly enforce certain things mandated by the spec
2855 * but otherwise ignored/worked around for interoperability. This is a
2856 * HW flag so drivers can opt in according to their own control, e.g. in
2857 * testing.
2858 *
2859 * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays
2860 */
2861 enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
2862 IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL,
2863 IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS,
2864 IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING,
2865 IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
2866 IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM,
2867 IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC,
2868 IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT,
2869 IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION,
2870 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS,
2871 IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK,
2872 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS,
2873 IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE,
2874 IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF,
2875 IEEE80211_HW_NO_VIRTUAL_MONITOR,
2876 IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF,
2877 IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL,
2878 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT,
2879 IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS,
2880 IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR,
2881 IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL,
2882 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK,
2883 IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS,
2884 IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW,
2885 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE,
2886 IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF,
2887 IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY,
2888 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES,
2889 IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA,
2890 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS,
2891 IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS,
2892 IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW,
2893 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU,
2894 IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS,
2895 IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR,
2896 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER,
2897 IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS,
2898 IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU,
2899 IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST,
2900 IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK,
2901 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG,
2902 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA,
2903 IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP,
2904 IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ,
2905 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW,
2906 IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ,
2907 IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN,
2908 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID,
2909 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID,
2910 IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT,
2911 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD,
2912 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD,
2913 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP,
2914 IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION,
2915 IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX,
2916 IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING,
2917 IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING_5GHZ,
2918 IEEE80211_HW_HANDLES_QUIET_CSA,
2919 IEEE80211_HW_STRICT,
2920
2921 /* keep last, obviously */
2922 NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS
2923 };
2924
2925 /**
2926 * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
2927 *
2928 * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
2929 * information for an 802.11 PHY.
2930 *
2931 * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
2932 * 802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
2933 * members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
2934 * and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
2935 * bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
2936 *
2937 * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
2938 *
2939 * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
2940 * along with this structure.
2941 *
2942 * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
2943 *
2944 * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
2945 * for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
2946 *
2947 * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb.
2948 * Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs.
2949 *
2950 * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
2951 * only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
2952 *
2953 * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
2954 * that HW supports
2955 *
2956 * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
2957 * data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
2958 * queues need to have configurable access parameters.
2959 *
2960 * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
2961 * If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
2962 * set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
2963 *
2964 * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2965 * within &struct ieee80211_vif.
2966 * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2967 * within &struct ieee80211_sta.
2968 * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2969 * within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf.
2970 * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2971 * within @struct ieee80211_txq.
2972 *
2973 * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
2974 * can handle.
2975 * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
2976 * the hw can report back.
2977 * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
2978 *
2979 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
2980 * sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
2981 * aggregation.
2982 * This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
2983 * number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
2984 * it shouldn't be set.
2985 *
2986 * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
2987 * aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll
2988 * advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if
2989 * the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N
2990 * with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012).
2991 * For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used.
2992 *
2993 * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum
2994 * of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list.
2995 *
2996 * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX
2997 * (if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set)
2998 *
2999 * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW
3000 * reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't
3001 * include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only
3002 * adding _BW is supported today.
3003 *
3004 * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports,
3005 * the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH.
3006 * Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values.
3007 *
3008 * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the
3009 * @units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp
3010 * field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status
3011 * device_timestamp.
3012 * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a
3013 * IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a
3014 * IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value.
3015 * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the
3016 * radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set.
3017 *
3018 * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created
3019 * from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211,
3020 * other features will be rejected during HW registration.
3021 *
3022 * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate
3023 * for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery-
3024 * enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap.
3025 * Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means
3026 * that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means
3027 * neither enabled.
3028 *
3029 * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may
3030 * deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA.
3031 * Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values.
3032 *
3033 * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the
3034 * device.
3035 *
3036 * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from
3037 * them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed,
3038 * unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers.
3039 *
3040 * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while
3041 * refilling deficit of each TXQ.
3042 *
3043 * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set.
3044 *
3045 * @tx_power_levels: a list of power levels supported by the wifi hardware.
3046 * The power levels can be specified either as integer or fractions.
3047 * The power level at idx 0 shall be the maximum positive power level.
3048 *
3049 * @max_txpwr_levels_idx: the maximum valid idx of 'tx_power_levels' list.
3050 */
3051 struct ieee80211_hw {
3052 struct ieee80211_conf conf;
3053 struct wiphy *wiphy;
3054 const char *rate_control_algorithm;
3055 void *priv;
3056 unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)];
3057 unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
3058 unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom;
3059 int vif_data_size;
3060 int sta_data_size;
3061 int chanctx_data_size;
3062 int txq_data_size;
3063 u16 queues;
3064 u16 max_listen_interval;
3065 s8 max_signal;
3066 u8 max_rates;
3067 u8 max_report_rates;
3068 u8 max_rate_tries;
3069 u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
3070 u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
3071 u8 max_tx_fragments;
3072 u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue;
3073 u8 radiotap_mcs_details;
3074 u16 radiotap_vht_details;
3075 struct {
3076 int units_pos;
3077 s16 accuracy;
3078 } radiotap_timestamp;
3079 netdev_features_t netdev_features;
3080 u8 uapsd_queues;
3081 u8 uapsd_max_sp_len;
3082 u8 max_nan_de_entries;
3083 u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift;
3084 u8 weight_multiplier;
3085 u32 max_mtu;
3086 const s8 *tx_power_levels;
3087 u8 max_txpwr_levels_idx;
3088 };
3089
_ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)3090 static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3091 enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
3092 {
3093 return test_bit(flg, hw->flags);
3094 }
3095 #define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg) _ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
3096
_ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)3097 static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3098 enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
3099 {
3100 return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags);
3101 }
3102 #define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg) _ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
3103
3104 /**
3105 * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request
3106 *
3107 * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie)
3108 * @req: cfg80211 request.
3109 */
3110 struct ieee80211_scan_request {
3111 struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies;
3112
3113 /* Keep last */
3114 struct cfg80211_scan_request req;
3115 };
3116
3117 /**
3118 * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters
3119 *
3120 * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from
3121 * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request
3122 * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode
3123 * @status: channel-switch response status
3124 * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received
3125 * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
3126 * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
3127 * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template
3128 * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb
3129 */
3130 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params {
3131 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3132 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef;
3133 u8 action_code;
3134 u32 status;
3135 u32 timestamp;
3136 u16 switch_time;
3137 u16 switch_timeout;
3138 struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb;
3139 u32 ch_sw_tm_ie;
3140 };
3141
3142 /**
3143 * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
3144 *
3145 * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
3146 *
3147 * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
3148 * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
3149 * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
3150 * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
3151 * is already used internally by mac80211.
3152 *
3153 * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy.
3154 */
3155 struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
3156
3157 /**
3158 * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
3159 *
3160 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
3161 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
3162 */
SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct device * dev)3163 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
3164 {
3165 set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
3166 }
3167
3168 /**
3169 * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
3170 *
3171 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
3172 * @addr: the address to set
3173 */
SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const u8 * addr)3174 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr)
3175 {
3176 memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
3177 }
3178
3179 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c)3180 ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3181 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3182 {
3183 if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
3184 return NULL;
3185 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
3186 }
3187
3188 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c)3189 ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3190 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3191 {
3192 if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
3193 return NULL;
3194 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
3195 }
3196
3197 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c,int idx)3198 ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3199 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
3200 {
3201 if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
3202 return NULL;
3203 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
3204 }
3205
3206 /**
3207 * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb
3208 * @hw: the hardware
3209 * @skb: the skb
3210 *
3211 * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure
3212 * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported.
3213 */
3214 void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
3215
3216 /**
3217 * ieee80211_purge_tx_queue - purge TX skb queue
3218 * @hw: the hardware
3219 * @skbs: the skbs
3220 *
3221 * Free a set of transmit skbs. Use this function when device is going to stop
3222 * but some transmit skbs without TX status are still queued.
3223 * This function does not take the list lock and the caller must hold the
3224 * relevant locks to use it.
3225 */
3226 void ieee80211_purge_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3227 struct sk_buff_head *skbs);
3228
3229 /**
3230 * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
3231 *
3232 * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
3233 * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
3234 *
3235 * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
3236 * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
3237 * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
3238 * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
3239 * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
3240 * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
3241 * VLANs are configured for an access point.
3242 *
3243 * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
3244 * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
3245 * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
3246 *
3247 * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
3248 * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
3249 * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
3250 * hardware key index. You are free to use the full u8 range.
3251 *
3252 * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is
3253 * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if
3254 * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the
3255 * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software.
3256 *
3257 * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
3258 *
3259 * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
3260 * for it has been uploaded to hardware. The stack will not make any
3261 * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
3262 * based on the receive flags.
3263 *
3264 * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
3265 * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
3266 * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
3267 * keys.
3268 *
3269 * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
3270 * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
3271 * handler.
3272 * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
3273 * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
3274 * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
3275 * rekeying); it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
3276 * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
3277 * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
3278 *
3279 * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index
3280 * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required
3281 * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses).
3282 *
3283 * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag
3284 * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following
3285 * requirements:
3286 * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211
3287 once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed,
3288 2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued
3289 at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits),
3290 3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command
3291 encrypted with the new key when also needing
3292 @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and
3293 4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted.
3294 Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver.
3295 */
3296
3297 /**
3298 * DOC: Powersave support
3299 *
3300 * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
3301 *
3302 * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself;
3303 * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
3304 * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
3305 * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
3306 * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
3307 * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
3308 * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
3309 * it finds traffic directed to it.
3310 *
3311 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
3312 * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
3313 * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
3314 * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
3315 * back to sleep at appropriate times.
3316 *
3317 * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
3318 * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
3319 * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
3320 *
3321 * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
3322 * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
3323 * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
3324 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
3325 * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
3326 * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
3327 * as best as it can; mac80211 is too slow to do that.
3328 *
3329 * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
3330 * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
3331 * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
3332 * the next wakeup. It's a compromise of getting good enough latency when
3333 * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
3334 * periods.
3335 *
3336 * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
3337 * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
3338 * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
3339 * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
3340 * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
3341 * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
3342 * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
3343 * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
3344 * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
3345 * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
3346 *
3347 * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
3348 * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
3349 * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
3350 * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
3351 * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
3352 * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
3353 *
3354 * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
3355 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
3356 */
3357
3358 /**
3359 * DOC: Beacon filter support
3360 *
3361 * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
3362 * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that
3363 * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
3364 * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
3365 * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
3366 * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
3367 * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
3368 *
3369 * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER
3370 * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
3371 * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
3372 * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
3373 * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
3374 *
3375 * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
3376 * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
3377 * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
3378 * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
3379 *
3380 * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
3381 * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
3382 * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
3383 * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
3384 *
3385 * - a list of information element IDs
3386 * - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
3387 *
3388 * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
3389 * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
3390 * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
3391 * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
3392 * vendor information elements.
3393 *
3394 * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
3395 * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
3396 *
3397 * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead. Just make sure nothing
3398 * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
3399 * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
3400 * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
3401 * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
3402 * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
3403 *
3404 *
3405 * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
3406 * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
3407 * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
3408 * the received data packets). This can consist of notifying the host when
3409 * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
3410 * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
3411 * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
3412 * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
3413 *
3414 * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
3415 * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
3416 * signal strength threshold checking.
3417 */
3418
3419 /**
3420 * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
3421 *
3422 * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
3423 * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
3424 * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
3425 * "11.2.3 SM power save".
3426 *
3427 * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
3428 * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
3429 * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
3430 * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
3431 * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
3432 * hardware flags.
3433 *
3434 * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
3435 * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
3436 * turned off otherwise.
3437 *
3438 * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
3439 * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
3440 * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
3441 * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
3442 */
3443
3444 /**
3445 * DOC: Frame filtering
3446 *
3447 * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
3448 * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
3449 * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
3450 * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
3451 * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
3452 *
3453 * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
3454 * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
3455 * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
3456 *
3457 * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
3458 * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
3459 * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
3460 * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
3461 * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
3462 * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
3463 * @total_flags with the new flag states.
3464 *
3465 * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
3466 * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
3467 * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
3468 * or dropped.
3469 *
3470 * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
3471 * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
3472 * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
3473 * the flag, but not clear it.
3474 * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
3475 * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
3476 * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
3477 * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
3478 * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
3479 * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
3480 * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
3481 * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
3482 */
3483
3484 /**
3485 * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients
3486 *
3487 * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for
3488 * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD.
3489 * There currently is no support for sAPSD.
3490 *
3491 * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client
3492 * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time.
3493 * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but
3494 * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies
3495 * the driver code.
3496 *
3497 * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete
3498 * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set,
3499 * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for
3500 * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames.
3501 * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of
3502 * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't
3503 * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD.
3504 *
3505 * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the
3506 * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a
3507 * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is,
3508 * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is
3509 * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this
3510 * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to
3511 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will
3512 * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The
3513 * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its
3514 * @sta_notify callback.
3515 *
3516 * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up,
3517 * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period.
3518 * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and
3519 * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When
3520 * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211
3521 * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames
3522 * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit
3523 * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER
3524 * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only
3525 * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to
3526 * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have
3527 * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS.
3528 * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is
3529 * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer.
3530 *
3531 * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by
3532 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them.
3533 *
3534 * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi
3535 * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up
3536 * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being
3537 * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong
3538 * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be
3539 * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to
3540 * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can
3541 * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it
3542 * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames
3543 * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again
3544 * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked.
3545 *
3546 * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any
3547 * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is
3548 * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any
3549 * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up
3550 * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when
3551 * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service
3552 * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called
3553 * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are
3554 * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting
3555 * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames.
3556 * To help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if
3557 * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames
3558 * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the
3559 * buffers for those TIDs contain.
3560 *
3561 * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may
3562 * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must
3563 * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that
3564 * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid
3565 * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released
3566 * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp()
3567 * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway.
3568 *
3569 * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211
3570 * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags
3571 * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
3572 * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame.
3573 * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case.
3574 *
3575 * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data
3576 * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as
3577 * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame
3578 * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed.
3579 */
3580
3581 /**
3582 * DOC: HW queue control
3583 *
3584 * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static
3585 * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This
3586 * was problematic for a few reasons:
3587 * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames
3588 * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly
3589 * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames
3590 *
3591 * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all
3592 * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it
3593 * won't have the same problem with the software queues.
3594 *
3595 * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability
3596 * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do
3597 * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif
3598 * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will
3599 * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and
3600 * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors
3601 * the hardware queue.
3602 * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue
3603 * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.)
3604 *
3605 * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed; multiple virtual
3606 * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to
3607 * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a
3608 * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have
3609 * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios:
3610 *
3611 * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3
3612 * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7
3613 * after-DTIM queue for AP: 8
3614 * off-channel queue: 9
3615 *
3616 * It would then set up the hardware like this:
3617 * hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9
3618 *
3619 * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows:
3620 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0
3621 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1
3622 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2
3623 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3
3624 * vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3625 * and the second virtual interface with 4-7.
3626 *
3627 * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second
3628 * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC.
3629 *
3630 * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3631 * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the
3632 * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when
3633 * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode.
3634 */
3635
3636 /**
3637 * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
3638 *
3639 * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
3640 * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
3641 * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
3642 * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
3643 *
3644 * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
3645 * by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
3646 * multicast address.
3647 *
3648 * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
3649 * %RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
3650 *
3651 * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
3652 * the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
3653 *
3654 * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
3655 * to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
3656 * by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
3657 * mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
3658 * honour this flag if possible.
3659 *
3660 * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this
3661 * station
3662 *
3663 * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
3664 *
3665 * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames
3666 *
3667 * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
3668 *
3669 * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames
3670 */
3671 enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
3672 FIF_ALLMULTI = 1<<1,
3673 FIF_FCSFAIL = 1<<2,
3674 FIF_PLCPFAIL = 1<<3,
3675 FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC = 1<<4,
3676 FIF_CONTROL = 1<<5,
3677 FIF_OTHER_BSS = 1<<6,
3678 FIF_PSPOLL = 1<<7,
3679 FIF_PROBE_REQ = 1<<8,
3680 FIF_MCAST_ACTION = 1<<9,
3681 };
3682
3683 /**
3684 * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
3685 *
3686 * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
3687 * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
3688 *
3689 * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
3690 * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
3691 * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
3692 * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
3693 *
3694 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation
3695 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation
3696 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either
3697 * call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or
3698 * call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status
3699 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after
3700 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special
3701 * status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE.
3702 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
3703 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting
3704 * queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the
3705 * driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe().
3706 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets,
3707 * called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call
3708 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the
3709 * session is gone and removes the station.
3710 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped
3711 * but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and
3712 * now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers
3713 * should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called.
3714 */
3715 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
3716 IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
3717 IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
3718 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
3719 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT,
3720 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH,
3721 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT,
3722 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
3723 };
3724
3725 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1
3726 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2
3727
3728 /**
3729 * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters
3730 *
3731 * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3732 * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session
3733 * @tid: tid of the BA session
3734 * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When
3735 * action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the
3736 * actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here.
3737 * @buf_size: reorder buffer size (number of subframes). Valid only when the
3738 * action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or
3739 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3740 * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU.
3741 * valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3742 * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to
3743 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START
3744 */
3745 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params {
3746 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action;
3747 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3748 u16 tid;
3749 u16 ssn;
3750 u16 buf_size;
3751 bool amsdu;
3752 u16 timeout;
3753 };
3754
3755 /**
3756 * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason
3757 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll
3758 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to
3759 * frame received on trigger-enabled AC
3760 */
3761 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type {
3762 IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL,
3763 IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD,
3764 };
3765
3766 /**
3767 * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed
3768 *
3769 * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit
3770 * to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station
3771 * information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40
3772 * flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes.
3773 * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed.
3774 * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer
3775 * changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about
3776 * the peer.
3777 * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed
3778 * by the peer
3779 */
3780 enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed {
3781 IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED = BIT(0),
3782 IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED = BIT(1),
3783 IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED = BIT(2),
3784 IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED = BIT(3),
3785 };
3786
3787 /**
3788 * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type
3789 *
3790 * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations,
3791 * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other
3792 * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa).
3793 * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC
3794 * operations compared to other operations/flows.
3795 *
3796 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC.
3797 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required
3798 * for sending management frames offchannel.
3799 */
3800 enum ieee80211_roc_type {
3801 IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0,
3802 IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX,
3803 };
3804
3805 /**
3806 * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type
3807 *
3808 * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what
3809 * reconfiguration type was completed.
3810 *
3811 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type
3812 * (also due to resume() callback returning 1)
3813 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless
3814 * of wowlan configuration)
3815 */
3816 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type {
3817 IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART,
3818 IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND,
3819 };
3820
3821 /**
3822 * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information
3823 * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration,
3824 * only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3825 * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc)
3826 * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only
3827 * used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only
3828 * valid for auth and (re)assoc.
3829 * @was_assoc: set if this call is due to deauth/disassoc
3830 * while just having been associated
3831 * @link_id: the link id on which the frame will be TX'ed.
3832 * Only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3833 */
3834 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info {
3835 u16 duration;
3836 u16 subtype;
3837 u8 success:1, was_assoc:1;
3838 int link_id;
3839 };
3840
3841 /**
3842 * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
3843 *
3844 * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
3845 * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
3846 * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
3847 *
3848 * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
3849 * skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
3850 * The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
3851 * configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
3852 * preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately.
3853 * Must be atomic.
3854 *
3855 * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
3856 * is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
3857 * frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
3858 * Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
3859 * or zero.
3860 * When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
3861 * to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
3862 * is added.
3863 * Must be implemented and can sleep.
3864 *
3865 * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
3866 * is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
3867 * it must turn off frame reception.)
3868 * May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
3869 * an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
3870 * you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
3871 * Must be implemented and can sleep.
3872 *
3873 * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
3874 * stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
3875 * ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
3876 * configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
3877 * reconfigured at resume time.
3878 * The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
3879 * wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
3880 * supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
3881 * must return 1 from this function.
3882 *
3883 * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
3884 * now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
3885 * functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
3886 * to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
3887 * will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
3888 *
3889 * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is
3890 * modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is
3891 * supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only
3892 * in suspend().
3893 *
3894 * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
3895 * enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
3896 * and @stop must be implemented.
3897 * The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
3898 * the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
3899 * interface is given in the conf parameter.
3900 * The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
3901 * negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
3902 * Must be implemented and can sleep.
3903 *
3904 * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
3905 * is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
3906 * switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
3907 * Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
3908 * found by the interface iteration callbacks.
3909 *
3910 * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
3911 * The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
3912 * and no monitor interfaces are present.
3913 * When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
3914 * must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
3915 * the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
3916 * MAC address of the device going away.
3917 * Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
3918 *
3919 * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
3920 * function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
3921 * This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
3922 * if it does. The callback can sleep.
3923 *
3924 * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
3925 * parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
3926 * level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
3927 * This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
3928 * for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
3929 * of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
3930 * can sleep.
3931 * Note: this callback is called if @vif_cfg_changed or @link_info_changed
3932 * are not implemented.
3933 *
3934 * @vif_cfg_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to interface
3935 * (MLD) parameters from &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg that vary during the
3936 * lifetime of the interface (e.g. assoc status, IP addresses, etc.)
3937 * The @changed parameter indicates which value changed.
3938 * The callback can sleep.
3939 *
3940 * @link_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to link
3941 * parameters from &struct ieee80211_bss_conf that are related to an
3942 * individual link. e.g. legacy/HT/VHT/... rate information.
3943 * The @changed parameter indicates which value changed, and the @link_id
3944 * parameter indicates the link ID. Note that the @link_id will be 0 for
3945 * non-MLO connections.
3946 * The callback can sleep.
3947 *
3948 * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
3949 * This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
3950 * to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
3951 *
3952 * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
3953 * See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
3954 * This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
3955 *
3956 * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter.
3957 * This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames
3958 * should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination
3959 * of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates
3960 * which flags are changed.
3961 * This callback can sleep.
3962 *
3963 * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
3964 * must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
3965 *
3966 * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3967 * This callback is only called between add_interface and
3968 * remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
3969 * is enabled.
3970 * Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
3971 * The callback can sleep.
3972 *
3973 * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3974 * This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
3975 * which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
3976 * The callback must be atomic.
3977 *
3978 * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
3979 * host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
3980 * necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
3981 * After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
3982 * userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
3983 *
3984 * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for
3985 * WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP
3986 * offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it.
3987 *
3988 * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
3989 * the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
3990 * configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
3991 * registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
3992 * that power save is disabled.
3993 * The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
3994 * entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
3995 * at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
3996 * (extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
3997 * When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
3998 * note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
3999 * any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
4000 * This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1,
4001 * this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a
4002 * software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this
4003 * capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't
4004 * advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is.
4005 * The callback can sleep.
4006 *
4007 * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
4008 * The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
4009 * but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
4010 * ieee80211_scan_completed().
4011 * This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
4012 * scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
4013 * The callback can sleep.
4014 *
4015 * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
4016 * specific intervals. The driver must call the
4017 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
4018 * This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
4019 *
4020 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
4021 * In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called.
4022 *
4023 * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
4024 * is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
4025 * The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR,
4026 * the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it
4027 * can use this parameter. The callback can sleep.
4028 *
4029 * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
4030 * software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
4031 * this notification.
4032 * The callback can sleep.
4033 *
4034 * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
4035 * Returns zero if statistics are available.
4036 * The callback can sleep.
4037 *
4038 * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does
4039 * IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the
4040 * IV/PN for the given key from hardware.
4041 * The callback must be atomic.
4042 *
4043 * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
4044 * if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the
4045 * stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG
4046 * should be set as well.
4047 * The callback can sleep.
4048 *
4049 * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
4050 * The callback can sleep.
4051 *
4052 * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
4053 * AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
4054 *
4055 * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
4056 * station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback
4057 * returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected;
4058 * no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing
4059 * the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
4060 * This callback can sleep.
4061 *
4062 * @vif_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add a debugfs vif
4063 * directory with its files. This callback should be within a
4064 * CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
4065 *
4066 * @link_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4067 * when a link is added to a mac80211 vif. This callback should be within
4068 * a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
4069 * For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the default bss_conf
4070 * with the vif's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
4071 *
4072 * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4073 * when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback
4074 * should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
4075 * callback can sleep.
4076 *
4077 * @link_sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4078 * when a link is added to a mac80211 station. This callback
4079 * should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
4080 * callback can sleep.
4081 * For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the deflink with the
4082 * station's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
4083 *
4084 * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
4085 * associated station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
4086 * in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
4087 * %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
4088 *
4089 * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx
4090 * power for the station.
4091 * This callback can sleep.
4092 *
4093 * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a
4094 * station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.)
4095 * This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove.
4096 * It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions
4097 * up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it
4098 * isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace
4099 * period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station.
4100 * See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
4101 * The callback can sleep.
4102 *
4103 * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU
4104 * synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station
4105 * pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear
4106 * the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse
4107 * in @sta_state.
4108 * The callback can sleep.
4109 *
4110 * @link_sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can
4111 * be used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits
4112 * from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected
4113 * in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver
4114 * uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since
4115 * otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly.
4116 * Must be atomic.
4117 * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This
4118 * is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses
4119 * the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic.
4120 *
4121 * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon
4122 * filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so
4123 * let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of
4124 * the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not
4125 * all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible.
4126 * Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
4127 * The callback can sleep.
4128 *
4129 * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
4130 * bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
4131 * Returns a negative error code on failure.
4132 * The callback can sleep.
4133 *
4134 * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
4135 * this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
4136 * required function.
4137 * The callback can sleep.
4138 *
4139 * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
4140 * Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
4141 * required function.
4142 * The callback can sleep.
4143 *
4144 * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the
4145 * firmware/hardware. Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between
4146 * calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up
4147 * as TSF delay. Is not a required function.
4148 * The callback can sleep.
4149 *
4150 * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
4151 * with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
4152 * function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
4153 * TSF synchronization.
4154 * The callback can sleep.
4155 *
4156 * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
4157 * This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
4158 * used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
4159 * Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
4160 * The callback can sleep.
4161 *
4162 * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
4163 *
4164 * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
4165 * need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
4166 * and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
4167 * The callback can sleep.
4168 *
4169 * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
4170 * in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
4171 * accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout
4172 * estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for
4173 * coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep.
4174 *
4175 * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may
4176 * be %NULL. The callback can sleep.
4177 * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
4178 *
4179 * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
4180 * that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap
4181 * of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces
4182 * use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues.
4183 * If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped.
4184 * Note that vif can be NULL.
4185 * The callback can sleep.
4186 *
4187 * @flush_sta: Flush or drop all pending frames from the hardware queue(s) for
4188 * the given station, as it's about to be removed.
4189 * The callback can sleep.
4190 *
4191 * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
4192 * switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
4193 * callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
4194 * completion of the channel switch.
4195 *
4196 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
4197 * Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
4198 * reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
4199 * (also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
4200 *
4201 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
4202 *
4203 * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
4204 * call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
4205 * that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
4206 * offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
4207 * normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
4208 * duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
4209 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired().
4210 * Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and
4211 * must be accepted in this case.
4212 * This callback may sleep.
4213 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
4214 * aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
4215 *
4216 * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
4217 *
4218 * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
4219 *
4220 * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
4221 * queues before entering power save.
4222 *
4223 * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
4224 * when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
4225 * The callback can sleep.
4226 * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See
4227 * &enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types.
4228 * The callback must be atomic.
4229 *
4230 * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given
4231 * parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for
4232 * sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver
4233 * to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD.
4234 * Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check
4235 * if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than
4236 * the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in
4237 * the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the
4238 * more-data bit must always be set.
4239 * The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames
4240 * from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set.
4241 * In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the
4242 * @num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In
4243 * this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4244 * on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll
4245 * period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple
4246 * responses for a retried PS-poll frame.
4247 * In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be
4248 * bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send
4249 * at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for
4250 * setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the
4251 * service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP
4252 * on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function
4253 * ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP.
4254 * This callback must be atomic.
4255 * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames
4256 * to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211
4257 * via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames
4258 * released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set
4259 * and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case
4260 * frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder
4261 * them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4262 * on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP
4263 * bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the
4264 * ieee80211_sta_eosp() function.
4265 * The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the
4266 * frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set.
4267 * This callback must be atomic.
4268 *
4269 * @get_et_sset_count: Ethtool API to get string-set count.
4270 * Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's
4271 * expected to return a static value.
4272 *
4273 * @get_et_stats: Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats.
4274 *
4275 * @get_et_strings: Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats
4276 * and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets.
4277 * Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's
4278 * expected to return a static value.
4279 *
4280 * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association
4281 * before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is
4282 * bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated
4283 * yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any
4284 * transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's
4285 * powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a
4286 * management frame prior to transmitting that frame to allow the driver
4287 * to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response and be
4288 * able to synchronize with the GO.
4289 * The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return
4290 * mac80211 will transmit the frame right away.
4291 * Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info
4292 * data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the
4293 * driver the duration for which the operation is requested.
4294 * The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep.
4295 * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously
4296 * transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data
4297 * is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used.
4298 *
4299 * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending
4300 * a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's
4301 * channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS
4302 * setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP.
4303 * mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS
4304 * discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least
4305 * 2 * (DTIM period).
4306 * The callback is optional and can sleep.
4307 *
4308 * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation.
4309 * This callback may sleep.
4310 * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction.
4311 * This callback may sleep.
4312 * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that
4313 * may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same
4314 * channel context with different settings
4315 * This callback may sleep.
4316 * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound
4317 * to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping.
4318 * This callback may sleep.
4319 * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being
4320 * unbound from vif.
4321 * This callback may sleep.
4322 * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to
4323 * another, as specified in the list of
4324 * @ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according
4325 * to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode.
4326 * This callback may sleep.
4327 *
4328 * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the
4329 * information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel
4330 * context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses
4331 * software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is
4332 * just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being
4333 * disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed.
4334 * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface.
4335 *
4336 * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and
4337 * during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed.
4338 * This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and
4339 * indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames).
4340 * This callback may sleep.
4341 *
4342 * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed.
4343 * Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces.
4344 * This callback is optional; it must not sleep.
4345 *
4346 * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel.
4347 * Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this
4348 * function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be
4349 * decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call
4350 * ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get()
4351 * get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is
4352 * 1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been
4353 * transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish().
4354 * If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called,
4355 * since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway.
4356 * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4357 * before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA
4358 * gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing
4359 * the driver to prepare for the channel switch.
4360 * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4361 * after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the
4362 * driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4363 * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4364 * when channel switch procedure was aborted, allowing the
4365 * driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4366 * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called
4367 * when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with
4368 * CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count.
4369 * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all
4370 * information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A
4371 * channel context is bound before this is called.
4372 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again.
4373 *
4374 * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the
4375 * specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0
4376 * if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide.
4377 *
4378 * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration
4379 * and hardware limits.
4380 *
4381 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4382 * is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4383 * and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The
4384 * driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of
4385 * the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation.
4386 * The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can
4387 * optionally copy the skb for further re-use.
4388 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4389 * peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4390 * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or
4391 * response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets
4392 * parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue
4393 * an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch
4394 * response template is provided, together with the location of the
4395 * switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within
4396 * the function call.
4397 *
4398 * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue.
4399 * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a
4400 * synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues
4401 * pending frames that were received prior to the control path action
4402 * currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet.
4403 *
4404 * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one.
4405 * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster.
4406 * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf
4407 * contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters
4408 * are changed with respect to the last NAN config.
4409 * The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since
4410 * some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the
4411 * changed parameters.
4412 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in
4413 * cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of
4414 * this call.
4415 * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call
4416 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with
4417 * NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal.
4418 * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports
4419 * aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation
4420 * between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while
4421 * skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU.
4422 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4423 * Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4424 *
4425 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep)
4426 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep)
4427 * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep.
4428 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer.
4429 * This callback may sleep.
4430 * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags
4431 * This callback may sleep.
4432 * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using
4433 * 4-address mode
4434 * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4435 * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed
4436 * to use rx decapsulation offload
4437 * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer.
4438 * This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters
4439 * are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement.
4440 * The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of
4441 * twt structure.
4442 * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received
4443 * from the peer.
4444 * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4445 * radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4446 * or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4447 * Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4448 * switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4449 * radar channel.
4450 * The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4451 * disable background CAC/radar detection.
4452 * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to
4453 * resolve a path for hardware flow offloading
4454 * @can_activate_links: Checks if a specific active_links bitmap is
4455 * supported by the driver.
4456 * @change_vif_links: Change the valid links on an interface, note that while
4457 * removing the old link information is still valid (link_conf pointer),
4458 * but may immediately disappear after the function returns. The old or
4459 * new links bitmaps may be 0 if going from/to a non-MLO situation.
4460 * The @old array contains pointers to the old bss_conf structures
4461 * that were already removed, in case they're needed.
4462 * This callback can sleep.
4463 * @change_sta_links: Change the valid links of a station, similar to
4464 * @change_vif_links. This callback can sleep.
4465 * Note that a sta can also be inserted or removed with valid links,
4466 * i.e. passed to @sta_add/@sta_state with sta->valid_links not zero.
4467 * In fact, cannot change from having valid_links and not having them.
4468 * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames. This is
4469 * not restored at HW reset by mac80211 so drivers need to take care of
4470 * that.
4471 * @net_setup_tc: Called from .ndo_setup_tc in order to prepare hardware
4472 * flow offloading for flows originating from the vif.
4473 * Note that the driver must not assume that the vif driver_data is valid
4474 * at this point, since the callback can be called during netdev teardown.
4475 * @can_neg_ttlm: for managed interface, requests the driver to determine
4476 * if the requested TID-To-Link mapping can be accepted or not.
4477 * If it's not accepted the driver may suggest a preferred mapping and
4478 * modify @ttlm parameter with the suggested TID-to-Link mapping.
4479 * @prep_add_interface: prepare for interface addition. This can be used by
4480 * drivers to prepare for the addition of a new interface, e.g., allocate
4481 * the needed resources etc. This callback doesn't guarantee that an
4482 * interface with the specified type would be added, and thus drivers that
4483 * implement this callback need to handle such cases. The type is the full
4484 * &enum nl80211_iftype.
4485 */
4486 struct ieee80211_ops {
4487 void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4488 struct ieee80211_tx_control *control,
4489 struct sk_buff *skb);
4490 int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4491 void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool suspend);
4492 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
4493 int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
4494 int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4495 void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled);
4496 #endif
4497 int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4498 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4499 int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4500 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4501 enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
4502 void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4503 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4504 int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed);
4505 void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4506 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4507 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4508 u64 changed);
4509 void (*vif_cfg_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4510 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4511 u64 changed);
4512 void (*link_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4513 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4514 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4515 u64 changed);
4516
4517 int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4518 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4519 void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4520 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4521
4522 u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4523 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
4524 void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4525 unsigned int changed_flags,
4526 unsigned int *total_flags,
4527 u64 multicast);
4528 void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4529 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4530 unsigned int filter_flags,
4531 unsigned int changed_flags);
4532 int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4533 bool set);
4534 int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
4535 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4536 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
4537 void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4538 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4539 struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
4540 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4541 u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
4542 void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4543 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4544 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4545 void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4546 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx);
4547 int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4548 struct ieee80211_scan_request *req);
4549 void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4550 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4551 int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4552 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4553 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
4554 struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies);
4555 int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4556 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4557 void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4558 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4559 const u8 *mac_addr);
4560 void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4561 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4562 int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4563 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
4564 void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4565 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
4566 struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
4567 int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4568 int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4569 int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4570 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4571 int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4572 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4573 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
4574 void (*vif_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4575 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4576 void (*link_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4577 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4578 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4579 struct dentry *dir);
4580 void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4581 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4582 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4583 struct dentry *dir);
4584 void (*link_sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4585 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4586 struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4587 struct dentry *dir);
4588 #endif
4589 void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4590 enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4591 int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4592 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4593 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4594 int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4595 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4596 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state,
4597 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state);
4598 void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4599 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4600 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4601 void (*link_sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4602 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4603 struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4604 u32 changed);
4605 void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4606 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4607 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4608 void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4609 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4610 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4611 struct station_info *sinfo);
4612 int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4613 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4614 unsigned int link_id, u16 ac,
4615 const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
4616 u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4617 void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4618 u64 tsf);
4619 void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4620 s64 offset);
4621 void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4622 int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4623
4624 /**
4625 * @ampdu_action:
4626 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action.
4627 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
4628 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
4629 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
4630 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver
4631 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size
4632 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
4633 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
4634 * possible with a buf_size of 8:
4635 *
4636 * - ``TX: 1.....7``
4637 * - ``RX: 2....7`` (lost frame #1)
4638 * - ``TX: 8..1...``
4639 *
4640 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
4641 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
4642 *
4643 * - ``TX: 1 or``
4644 * - ``TX: 18 or``
4645 * - ``TX: 81``
4646 *
4647 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
4648 *
4649 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return
4650 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START
4651 * if the session can start immediately.
4652 *
4653 * The callback can sleep.
4654 */
4655 int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4656 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4657 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params);
4658 int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
4659 struct survey_info *survey);
4660 void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4661 void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, s16 coverage_class);
4662 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4663 int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4664 void *data, int len);
4665 int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
4666 struct netlink_callback *cb,
4667 void *data, int len);
4668 #endif
4669 void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4670 u32 queues, bool drop);
4671 void (*flush_sta)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4672 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4673 void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4674 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4675 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4676 int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4677 int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4678
4679 int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4680 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4681 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4682 int duration,
4683 enum ieee80211_roc_type type);
4684 int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4685 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4686 int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
4687 void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4688 u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
4689 bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4690 int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4691 const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4692 void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4693 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4694 const struct ieee80211_event *event);
4695
4696 void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4697 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4698 u16 tids, int num_frames,
4699 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4700 bool more_data);
4701 void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4702 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4703 u16 tids, int num_frames,
4704 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4705 bool more_data);
4706
4707 int (*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4708 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset);
4709 void (*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4710 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4711 struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data);
4712 void (*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4713 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4714 u32 sset, u8 *data);
4715
4716 void (*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4717 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4718 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4719 void (*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4720 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4721 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4722
4723 void (*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4724 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4725 unsigned int link_id);
4726
4727 int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4728 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4729 void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4730 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4731 void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4732 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
4733 u32 changed);
4734 int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4735 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4736 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4737 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4738 void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4739 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4740 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4741 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4742 int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4743 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
4744 int n_vifs,
4745 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
4746
4747 void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4748 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type);
4749
4750 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6)
4751 void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4752 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4753 struct inet6_dev *idev);
4754 #endif
4755 void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4756 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4757 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4758 int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4759 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4760 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4761
4762 int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4763 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4764 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4765 void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4766 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4767 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4768 void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4769 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4770 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4771
4772 int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4773 void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4774 u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4775 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4776 int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4777 unsigned int link_id, int *dbm);
4778
4779 int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4780 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4781 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class,
4782 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4783 struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie);
4784 void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4785 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4786 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4787 void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4788 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4789 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params);
4790
4791 void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4792 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
4793 void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4794
4795 int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4796 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4797 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4798 int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4799 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4800 int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4801 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4802 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes);
4803 int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4804 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4805 const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4806 void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4807 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4808 u8 instance_id);
4809 bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4810 struct sk_buff *head,
4811 struct sk_buff *skb);
4812 int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4813 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4814 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4815 int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4816 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4817 void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4818 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4819 int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4820 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4821 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4822 struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4823 int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4824 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4825 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids);
4826 void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4827 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4828 void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4829 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4830 int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4831 const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4832 void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4833 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4834 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4835 void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4836 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4837 struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt);
4838 void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4839 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid);
4840 int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4841 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4842 int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4843 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4844 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4845 struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx,
4846 struct net_device_path *path);
4847 bool (*can_activate_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4848 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4849 u16 active_links);
4850 int (*change_vif_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4851 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4852 u16 old_links, u16 new_links,
4853 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *old[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]);
4854 int (*change_sta_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4855 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4856 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4857 u16 old_links, u16 new_links);
4858 int (*set_hw_timestamp)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4859 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4860 struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts);
4861 int (*net_setup_tc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4862 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4863 struct net_device *dev,
4864 enum tc_setup_type type,
4865 void *type_data);
4866 enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res
4867 (*can_neg_ttlm)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4868 struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm *ttlm);
4869 void (*prep_add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4870 enum nl80211_iftype type);
4871 };
4872
4873 /**
4874 * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device
4875 *
4876 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4877 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4878 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4879 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4880 * @priv_data_len.
4881 *
4882 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4883 * @ops: callbacks for this device
4884 * @requested_name: Requested name for this device.
4885 * NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d)
4886 *
4887 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4888 */
4889 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len,
4890 const struct ieee80211_ops *ops,
4891 const char *requested_name);
4892
4893 /**
4894 * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device
4895 *
4896 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4897 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4898 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4899 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4900 * @priv_data_len.
4901 *
4902 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4903 * @ops: callbacks for this device
4904 *
4905 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4906 */
4907 static inline
ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,const struct ieee80211_ops * ops)4908 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
4909 const struct ieee80211_ops *ops)
4910 {
4911 return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL);
4912 }
4913
4914 /**
4915 * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
4916 *
4917 * You must call this function before any other functions in
4918 * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
4919 * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
4920 *
4921 * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
4922 *
4923 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
4924 */
4925 int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4926
4927 /**
4928 * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
4929 * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
4930 * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
4931 * (full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
4932 */
4933 struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
4934 int throughput;
4935 int blink_time;
4936 };
4937
4938 /**
4939 * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
4940 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
4941 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
4942 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
4943 * interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
4944 */
4945 enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
4946 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO = BIT(0),
4947 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK = BIT(1),
4948 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED = BIT(2),
4949 };
4950
4951 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4952 const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4953 const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4954 const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4955 const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4956 const char *
4957 __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4958 unsigned int flags,
4959 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4960 unsigned int blink_table_len);
4961 #endif
4962 /**
4963 * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
4964 *
4965 * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4966 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4967 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4968 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4969 *
4970 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4971 *
4972 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4973 */
ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4974 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4975 {
4976 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4977 return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
4978 #else
4979 return NULL;
4980 #endif
4981 }
4982
4983 /**
4984 * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
4985 *
4986 * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4987 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4988 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4989 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4990 *
4991 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4992 *
4993 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4994 */
ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4995 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4996 {
4997 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4998 return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
4999 #else
5000 return NULL;
5001 #endif
5002 }
5003
5004 /**
5005 * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
5006 *
5007 * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
5008 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
5009 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
5010 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
5011 *
5012 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
5013 *
5014 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
5015 */
ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)5016 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
5017 {
5018 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5019 return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
5020 #else
5021 return NULL;
5022 #endif
5023 }
5024
5025 /**
5026 * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
5027 *
5028 * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
5029 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
5030 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
5031 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
5032 *
5033 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
5034 *
5035 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
5036 */
ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)5037 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
5038 {
5039 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5040 return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
5041 #else
5042 return NULL;
5043 #endif
5044 }
5045
5046 /**
5047 * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
5048 * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
5049 * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
5050 * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
5051 * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
5052 *
5053 * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are
5054 * configured) or the name of the new trigger.
5055 *
5056 * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
5057 */
5058 static inline const char *
ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,unsigned int flags,const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink * blink_table,unsigned int blink_table_len)5059 ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
5060 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
5061 unsigned int blink_table_len)
5062 {
5063 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5064 return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
5065 blink_table_len);
5066 #else
5067 return NULL;
5068 #endif
5069 }
5070
5071 /**
5072 * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
5073 *
5074 * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
5075 * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
5076 *
5077 * @hw: the hardware to unregister
5078 */
5079 void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5080
5081 /**
5082 * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
5083 *
5084 * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
5085 * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
5086 * before calling this function.
5087 *
5088 * @hw: the hardware to free
5089 */
5090 void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5091
5092 /**
5093 * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
5094 *
5095 * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
5096 * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
5097 * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
5098 * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
5099 * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
5100 * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
5101 *
5102 * @hw: the hardware to restart
5103 */
5104 void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5105
5106 /**
5107 * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list
5108 *
5109 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5110 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5111 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5112 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5113 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5114 *
5115 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5116 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5117 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5118 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5119 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5120 *
5121 * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock
5122 *
5123 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5124 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
5125 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5126 * @list: the destination list
5127 */
5128 void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5129 struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list);
5130
5131 /**
5132 * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context
5133 *
5134 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5135 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5136 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5137 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5138 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5139 *
5140 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5141 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5142 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5143 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5144 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5145 *
5146 * This function must be called with BHs disabled.
5147 *
5148 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5149 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
5150 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5151 * @napi: the NAPI context
5152 */
5153 void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5154 struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi);
5155
5156 /**
5157 * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
5158 *
5159 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5160 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5161 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5162 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5163 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5164 *
5165 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5166 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5167 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5168 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5169 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5170 *
5171 * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
5172 *
5173 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5174 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5175 */
ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5176 static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb)
5177 {
5178 ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL);
5179 }
5180
5181 /**
5182 * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
5183 *
5184 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
5185 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5186 *
5187 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
5188 * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with
5189 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5190 *
5191 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5192 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5193 */
5194 void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
5195
5196 /**
5197 * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
5198 *
5199 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
5200 * (internally disables bottom halves).
5201 *
5202 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
5203 * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5204 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5205 *
5206 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5207 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5208 */
ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5209 static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5210 struct sk_buff *skb)
5211 {
5212 local_bh_disable();
5213 ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
5214 local_bh_enable();
5215 }
5216
5217 /**
5218 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
5219 *
5220 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
5221 * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
5222 * entering/leaving PS mode.
5223 *
5224 * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
5225 *
5226 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
5227 * each other.
5228 *
5229 * @sta: currently connected sta
5230 * @start: start or stop PS
5231 *
5232 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
5233 */
5234 int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
5235
5236 /**
5237 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
5238 * (in process context)
5239 *
5240 * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
5241 * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
5242 * applies.
5243 *
5244 * @sta: currently connected sta
5245 * @start: start or stop PS
5246 *
5247 * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition().
5248 */
ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta * sta,bool start)5249 static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5250 bool start)
5251 {
5252 int ret;
5253
5254 local_bh_disable();
5255 ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
5256 local_bh_enable();
5257
5258 return ret;
5259 }
5260
5261 /**
5262 * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received
5263 * @sta: currently connected station
5264 *
5265 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5266 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a
5267 * connected station was received.
5268 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5269 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must
5270 * be serialized.
5271 */
5272 void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
5273
5274 /**
5275 * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received
5276 * @sta: currently connected station
5277 * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame
5278 *
5279 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5280 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame
5281 * from a connected station was received.
5282 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5283 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be
5284 * serialized.
5285 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown.
5286 * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC
5287 * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper
5288 * checks.
5289 */
5290 void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
5291
5292 /*
5293 * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
5294 * This is enough for the radiotap header.
5295 */
5296 #define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM ALIGN(14, 4)
5297
5298 /**
5299 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames
5300 * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
5301 * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames
5302 * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID
5303 *
5304 * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
5305 * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need
5306 * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit.
5307 *
5308 * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are
5309 * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data
5310 * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim
5311 * call! Beware of the locking!)
5312 *
5313 * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD)
5314 * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are
5315 * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes
5316 * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data,
5317 * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered
5318 * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP).
5319 *
5320 * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per
5321 * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since
5322 * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the
5323 * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that
5324 * use this API.
5325 */
5326 void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5327 u8 tid, bool buffered);
5328
5329 /**
5330 * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet
5331 *
5332 * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support
5333 * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent
5334 * rate selection table for the station entry.
5335 *
5336 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5337 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent.
5338 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
5339 * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information
5340 * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch
5341 */
5342 void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5343 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5344 struct sk_buff *skb,
5345 struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest,
5346 int max_rates);
5347
5348 /**
5349 * ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput - set the expected tpt for a station
5350 *
5351 * Call this function to notify mac80211 about a change in expected throughput
5352 * to a station. A driver for a device that does rate control in firmware can
5353 * call this function when the expected throughput estimate towards a station
5354 * changes. The information is used to tune the CoDel AQM applied to traffic
5355 * going towards that station (which can otherwise be too aggressive and cause
5356 * slow stations to starve).
5357 *
5358 * @pubsta: the station to set throughput for.
5359 * @thr: the current expected throughput in kbps.
5360 */
5361 void ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5362 u32 thr);
5363
5364 /**
5365 * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback
5366 *
5367 * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta
5368 * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision
5369 * in updating the tx rate in data path.
5370 *
5371 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5372 * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for.
5373 * @info: tx status information
5374 */
5375 void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5376 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5377 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info);
5378
5379 /**
5380 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb - transmit status callback
5381 *
5382 * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
5383 * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
5384 * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
5385 *
5386 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5387 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
5388 * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
5389 * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5390 * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni().
5391 *
5392 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5393 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5394 */
5395 void ieee80211_tx_status_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5396 struct sk_buff *skb);
5397
5398 /**
5399 * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback
5400 *
5401 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb()
5402 * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not
5403 * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info.
5404 *
5405 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5406 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5407 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5408 *
5409 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5410 * @status: tx status information
5411 */
5412 void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5413 struct ieee80211_tx_status *status);
5414
5415 /**
5416 * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb
5417 *
5418 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb()
5419 * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to
5420 * specific skbs.
5421 *
5422 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5423 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5424 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5425 *
5426 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5427 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent
5428 * (NULL for multicast packets)
5429 * @info: tx status information
5430 */
ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_sta * sta,struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)5431 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5432 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5433 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
5434 {
5435 struct ieee80211_tx_status status = {
5436 .sta = sta,
5437 .info = info,
5438 };
5439
5440 ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status);
5441 }
5442
5443 /**
5444 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
5445 *
5446 * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in process context.
5447 *
5448 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and
5449 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
5450 * for a single hardware.
5451 *
5452 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5453 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5454 */
ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5455 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5456 struct sk_buff *skb)
5457 {
5458 local_bh_disable();
5459 ieee80211_tx_status_skb(hw, skb);
5460 local_bh_enable();
5461 }
5462
5463 /**
5464 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
5465 *
5466 * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in IRQ context
5467 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5468 *
5469 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and
5470 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5471 *
5472 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5473 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5474 */
5475 void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5476 struct sk_buff *skb);
5477
5478 /**
5479 * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
5480 *
5481 * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
5482 * connected STA.
5483 *
5484 * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
5485 * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
5486 */
5487 void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
5488
5489 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2
5490
5491 /**
5492 * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets
5493 * @tim_offset: position of TIM element
5494 * @tim_length: size of TIM element
5495 * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets
5496 * to countdown counters. This array can contain zero values which
5497 * should be ignored.
5498 * @mbssid_off: position of the multiple bssid element
5499 */
5500 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets {
5501 u16 tim_offset;
5502 u16 tim_length;
5503
5504 u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM];
5505 u16 mbssid_off;
5506 };
5507
5508 /**
5509 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function
5510 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5511 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5512 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5513 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5514 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5515 * that is not associated with AP MLD).
5516 *
5517 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5518 * obtain the beacon template.
5519 *
5520 * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the
5521 * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template
5522 * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when
5523 * applicable, the CSA count.
5524 *
5525 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5526 *
5527 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5528 */
5529 struct sk_buff *
5530 ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5531 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5532 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5533 unsigned int link_id);
5534
5535 /**
5536 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index - EMA beacon template generation
5537 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5538 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5539 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5540 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5541 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP).
5542 * @ema_index: index of the beacon in the EMA set.
5543 *
5544 * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5545 * but returns a beacon template which includes multiple BSSID element at the
5546 * requested index.
5547 *
5548 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL indicates the end of EMA templates.
5549 */
5550 struct sk_buff *
5551 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5552 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5553 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5554 unsigned int link_id, u8 ema_index);
5555
5556 /**
5557 * struct ieee80211_ema_beacons - List of EMA beacons
5558 * @cnt: count of EMA beacons.
5559 *
5560 * @bcn: array of EMA beacons.
5561 * @bcn.skb: the skb containing this specific beacon
5562 * @bcn.offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5563 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5564 */
5565 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons {
5566 u8 cnt;
5567 struct {
5568 struct sk_buff *skb;
5569 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets offs;
5570 } bcn[];
5571 };
5572
5573 /**
5574 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list - EMA beacon template generation
5575 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5576 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5577 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5578 *
5579 * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5580 * but allocates and returns a pointer to list of all beacon templates required
5581 * to cover all profiles in the multiple BSSID set. Each template includes only
5582 * one multiple BSSID element.
5583 *
5584 * Driver must call ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list() to free the memory.
5585 *
5586 * Return: EMA beacon templates of type struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *.
5587 * %NULL on error.
5588 */
5589 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *
5590 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5591 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5592 unsigned int link_id);
5593
5594 /**
5595 * ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list - free an EMA beacon template list
5596 * @ema_beacons: list of EMA beacons of type &struct ieee80211_ema_beacons pointers.
5597 *
5598 * This function will free a list previously acquired by calling
5599 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list()
5600 */
5601 void ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list(struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *ema_beacons);
5602
5603 /**
5604 * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
5605 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5606 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5607 * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
5608 * Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5609 * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
5610 * (including the ID and length bytes!).
5611 * Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5612 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5613 * that is not associated with AP MLD).
5614 *
5615 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5616 * obtain the beacon frame.
5617 *
5618 * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5619 * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
5620 * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly
5621 * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
5622 *
5623 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5624 *
5625 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5626 */
5627 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5628 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5629 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length,
5630 unsigned int link_id);
5631
5632 /**
5633 * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
5634 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5635 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5636 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5637 * that is not associated with AP MLD).
5638 *
5639 * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5640 *
5641 * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5642 */
ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_vif * vif,unsigned int link_id)5643 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5644 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5645 unsigned int link_id)
5646 {
5647 return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL, link_id);
5648 }
5649
5650 /**
5651 * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown
5652 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5653 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5654 *
5655 * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission.
5656 * This function is called implicitly when
5657 * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the
5658 * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this
5659 * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown.
5660 *
5661 * Return: new countdown value
5662 */
5663 u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5664 unsigned int link_id);
5665
5666 /**
5667 * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown
5668 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5669 * @counter: the new value for the counter
5670 *
5671 * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be
5672 * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211.
5673 *
5674 * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(),
5675 * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value.
5676 */
5677 void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter);
5678
5679 /**
5680 * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch
5681 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5682 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5683 *
5684 * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5685 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5686 * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed.
5687 */
5688 void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id);
5689
5690 /**
5691 * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1
5692 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5693 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5694 *
5695 * Return: %true if the countdown reached 1, %false otherwise
5696 */
5697 bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5698 unsigned int link_id);
5699
5700 /**
5701 * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change
5702 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5703 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5704 *
5705 * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5706 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5707 * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed
5708 */
5709 void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 link_id);
5710
5711 /**
5712 * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template
5713 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5714 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5715 *
5716 * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5717 * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller.
5718 *
5719 * Can only be called in AP mode.
5720 *
5721 * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error.
5722 */
5723 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5724 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5725
5726 /**
5727 * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
5728 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5729 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5730 *
5731 * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
5732 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5733 * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
5734 *
5735 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5736 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
5737 *
5738 * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error.
5739 */
5740 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5741 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5742
5743 /**
5744 * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
5745 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5746 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5747 * @link_id: If the vif is an MLD, get a frame with the link addresses
5748 * for the given link ID. For a link_id < 0 you get a frame with
5749 * MLD addresses, however useful that might be.
5750 * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set
5751 * if at all possible
5752 *
5753 * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
5754 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5755 * BSSID and address is used.
5756 *
5757 * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the
5758 * returned packet will be QoS NDP.
5759 *
5760 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5761 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
5762 *
5763 * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error.
5764 */
5765 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5766 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5767 int link_id, bool qos_ok);
5768
5769 /**
5770 * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5771 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5772 * @src_addr: source MAC address
5773 * @ssid: SSID buffer
5774 * @ssid_len: length of SSID
5775 * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs
5776 *
5777 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5778 * hardware.
5779 *
5780 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5781 */
5782 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5783 const u8 *src_addr,
5784 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
5785 size_t tailroom);
5786
5787 /**
5788 * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
5789 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5790 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5791 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5792 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5793 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5794 * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
5795 *
5796 * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5797 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5798 * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5799 * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
5800 */
5801 void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5802 const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5803 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5804 struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
5805
5806 /**
5807 * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
5808 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5809 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5810 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5811 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5812 *
5813 * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5814 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5815 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5816 *
5817 * Return: The duration.
5818 */
5819 __le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5820 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
5821 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5822
5823 /**
5824 * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
5825 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5826 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5827 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5828 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5829 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5830 * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
5831 *
5832 * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5833 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5834 * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5835 * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
5836 */
5837 void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5838 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5839 const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5840 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5841 struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
5842
5843 /**
5844 * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
5845 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5846 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5847 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5848 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5849 *
5850 * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5851 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5852 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5853 *
5854 * Return: The duration.
5855 */
5856 __le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5857 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5858 size_t frame_len,
5859 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5860
5861 /**
5862 * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
5863 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5864 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5865 * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on
5866 * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
5867 * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
5868 *
5869 * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
5870 * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
5871 *
5872 * Return: The duration.
5873 */
5874 __le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5875 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5876 enum nl80211_band band,
5877 size_t frame_len,
5878 struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
5879
5880 /**
5881 * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
5882 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5883 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5884 *
5885 * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
5886 * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
5887 * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
5888 * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
5889 * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame.
5890 *
5891 * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered
5892 * frames are available.
5893 *
5894 * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
5895 * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
5896 * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
5897 * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
5898 * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
5899 * use common code for all beacons.
5900 */
5901 struct sk_buff *
5902 ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5903
5904 /**
5905 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
5906 *
5907 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
5908 *
5909 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5910 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5911 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5912 */
5913 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5914 u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5915
5916 /**
5917 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
5918 *
5919 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
5920 * from the given packet.
5921 *
5922 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5923 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
5924 * with this P1K
5925 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5926 */
ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf * keyconf,struct sk_buff * skb,u16 * p1k)5927 static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5928 struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
5929 {
5930 struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
5931 const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
5932 u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
5933
5934 ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
5935 }
5936
5937 /**
5938 * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
5939 *
5940 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
5941 * and transmitter address.
5942 *
5943 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5944 * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
5945 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5946 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5947 */
5948 void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5949 const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5950
5951 /**
5952 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
5953 *
5954 * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
5955 * in the packet.
5956 *
5957 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5958 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
5959 * encrypted with this key
5960 * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
5961 */
5962 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5963 struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
5964
5965 /**
5966 * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos
5967 *
5968 * @pos: start of crypto header
5969 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5970 * @pn: PN to add
5971 *
5972 * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of
5973 * the packet payload)
5974 *
5975 * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should
5976 * point to the crypto header)
5977 */
5978 u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn);
5979
5980 /**
5981 * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
5982 *
5983 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5984 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5985 * the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5986 * CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5987 * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
5988 *
5989 * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
5990 * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
5991 * by the device and not by mac80211.
5992 *
5993 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5994 * can be done concurrently.
5995 */
5996 void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5997 int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5998
5999 /**
6000 * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter
6001 *
6002 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
6003 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
6004 * the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
6005 * CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
6006 * @seq: new sequence data
6007 *
6008 * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the
6009 * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK
6010 * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called
6011 * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211.
6012 *
6013 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
6014 * can be done concurrently.
6015 */
6016 void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
6017 int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
6018
6019 /**
6020 * ieee80211_remove_key - remove the given key
6021 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
6022 *
6023 * Context: Must be called with the wiphy mutex held.
6024 *
6025 * Remove the given key. If the key was uploaded to the hardware at the
6026 * time this function is called, it is not deleted in the hardware but
6027 * instead assumed to have been removed already.
6028 */
6029 void ieee80211_remove_key(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
6030
6031 /**
6032 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN
6033 * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on
6034 * @keyconf: new key data
6035 * @link_id: the link id of the key or -1 for non-MLO
6036 *
6037 * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new
6038 * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper
6039 * RX processing, so this function allows setting them.
6040 *
6041 * Return: the newly allocated key structure, which will have
6042 * similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to
6043 * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an
6044 * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc.
6045 *
6046 * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware
6047 * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK
6048 * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver
6049 * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses
6050 * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part
6051 * of the reconfiguration.
6052 *
6053 * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq()
6054 * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly.
6055 *
6056 * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware,
6057 * then it will attempt to remove it during this call. In many cases
6058 * this isn't what you want, so call ieee80211_remove_key() first for
6059 * the key that's being replaced.
6060 */
6061 struct ieee80211_key_conf *
6062 ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6063 struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
6064 int link_id);
6065
6066 /**
6067 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
6068 * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
6069 * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
6070 * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
6071 * @gfp: allocation flags
6072 */
6073 void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
6074 const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
6075
6076 /**
6077 * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key
6078 *
6079 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
6080 * at the same time.
6081 *
6082 * @keyconf: the key in question
6083 */
6084 void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
6085
6086 /**
6087 * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key
6088 *
6089 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
6090 * at the same time.
6091 *
6092 * @keyconf: the key in question
6093 */
6094 void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
6095
6096 /**
6097 * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
6098 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6099 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6100 *
6101 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
6102 */
6103 void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6104
6105 /**
6106 * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
6107 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6108 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6109 *
6110 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
6111 */
6112 void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6113
6114 /**
6115 * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
6116 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6117 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6118 *
6119 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_queue_stopped.
6120 *
6121 * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise.
6122 */
6123
6124 int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6125
6126 /**
6127 * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
6128 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6129 *
6130 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_stop_all_queues.
6131 */
6132 void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6133
6134 /**
6135 * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
6136 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6137 *
6138 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_wake_all_queues.
6139 */
6140 void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6141
6142 /**
6143 * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
6144 *
6145 * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
6146 * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
6147 * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
6148 * any context, including hardirq context.
6149 *
6150 * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
6151 * @info: information about the completed scan
6152 */
6153 void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6154 struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
6155
6156 /**
6157 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
6158 *
6159 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
6160 * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
6161 *
6162 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
6163 */
6164 void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6165
6166 /**
6167 * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
6168 *
6169 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
6170 * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
6171 * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
6172 * while associating, for instance.
6173 *
6174 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
6175 */
6176 void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6177
6178 /**
6179 * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags
6180 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have
6181 * been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware
6182 * reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new
6183 * interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they
6184 * haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
6185 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all
6186 * interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
6187 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up).
6188 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA
6189 * is not in the driver. This may fix crashes during firmware recovery
6190 * for instance.
6191 */
6192 enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags {
6193 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL = 0,
6194 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL = BIT(0),
6195 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE = BIT(1),
6196 IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER = BIT(2),
6197 };
6198
6199 /**
6200 * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces
6201 *
6202 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6203 * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as
6204 * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep.
6205 * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6206 *
6207 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6208 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6209 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6210 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6211 */
6212 void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6213 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6214 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6215 void *data);
6216
6217 /**
6218 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
6219 *
6220 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6221 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6222 * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
6223 * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
6224 * be used.
6225 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6226 *
6227 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6228 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6229 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6230 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6231 */
6232 static inline void
ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,u32 iter_flags,void (* iterator)(void * data,u8 * mac,struct ieee80211_vif * vif),void * data)6233 ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6234 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6235 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6236 void *data)
6237 {
6238 ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw,
6239 iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE,
6240 iterator, data);
6241 }
6242
6243 /**
6244 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
6245 *
6246 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6247 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6248 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6249 * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
6250 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6251 *
6252 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6253 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6254 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6255 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6256 */
6257 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6258 u32 iter_flags,
6259 void (*iterator)(void *data,
6260 u8 *mac,
6261 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6262 void *data);
6263
6264 /**
6265 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces
6266 *
6267 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6268 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6269 * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex.
6270 *
6271 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6272 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6273 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6274 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6275 */
6276 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6277 u32 iter_flags,
6278 void (*iterator)(void *data,
6279 u8 *mac,
6280 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6281 void *data);
6282
6283 /**
6284 * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations
6285 *
6286 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6287 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6288 * function for them.
6289 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6290 *
6291 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6292 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6293 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6294 */
6295 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6296 void (*iterator)(void *data,
6297 struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6298 void *data);
6299
6300 /**
6301 * ieee80211_iterate_stations_mtx - iterate stations
6302 *
6303 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6304 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6305 * function for them. This version can only be used while holding the wiphy
6306 * mutex.
6307 *
6308 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6309 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6310 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6311 */
6312 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6313 void (*iterator)(void *data,
6314 struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6315 void *data);
6316
6317 /**
6318 * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6319 *
6320 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
6321 * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
6322 *
6323 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6324 * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
6325 */
6326 void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
6327
6328 /**
6329 * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6330 *
6331 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
6332 * workqueue.
6333 *
6334 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6335 * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
6336 * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
6337 */
6338 void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6339 struct delayed_work *dwork,
6340 unsigned long delay);
6341
6342 /**
6343 * ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer - Refresh a tx agg session timer.
6344 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6345 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6346 *
6347 * This function allows low level driver to refresh tx agg session timer
6348 * to maintain BA session, the session level will still be managed by the
6349 * mac80211.
6350 *
6351 * Note: must be called in an RCU critical section.
6352 */
6353 void ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6354 u16 tid);
6355
6356 /**
6357 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
6358 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6359 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6360 * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
6361 *
6362 * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
6363 *
6364 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6365 * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6366 * will be managed by the mac80211.
6367 */
6368 int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
6369 u16 timeout);
6370
6371 /**
6372 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
6373 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6374 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6375 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6376 *
6377 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6378 * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
6379 * from any context.
6380 */
6381 void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6382 u16 tid);
6383
6384 /**
6385 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
6386 * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
6387 * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
6388 *
6389 * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
6390 *
6391 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6392 * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6393 * will be managed by the mac80211.
6394 */
6395 int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
6396
6397 /**
6398 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
6399 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6400 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6401 * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
6402 *
6403 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6404 * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
6405 * can be called from any context.
6406 */
6407 void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6408 u16 tid);
6409
6410 /**
6411 * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
6412 *
6413 * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
6414 * @addr: station's address
6415 *
6416 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6417 *
6418 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6419 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6420 */
6421 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6422 const u8 *addr);
6423
6424 /**
6425 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
6426 *
6427 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6428 * @addr: remote station's address
6429 * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
6430 *
6431 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6432 *
6433 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6434 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6435 *
6436 * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
6437 * the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
6438 * We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
6439 * logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
6440 * BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
6441 * In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
6442 * is not reliable.
6443 *
6444 * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
6445 */
6446 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6447 const u8 *addr,
6448 const u8 *localaddr);
6449
6450 /**
6451 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs - find STA by link addresses
6452 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6453 * @addr: remote station's link address
6454 * @localaddr: local link address, use %NULL for any (but avoid that)
6455 * @link_id: pointer to obtain the link ID if the STA is found,
6456 * may be %NULL if the link ID is not needed
6457 *
6458 * Obtain the STA by link address, must use RCU protection.
6459 *
6460 * Return: pointer to STA if found, otherwise %NULL.
6461 */
6462 struct ieee80211_sta *
6463 ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6464 const u8 *addr,
6465 const u8 *localaddr,
6466 unsigned int *link_id);
6467
6468 /**
6469 * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
6470 * @hw: the hardware
6471 * @pubsta: the station
6472 * @block: whether to block or unblock
6473 *
6474 * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
6475 * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
6476 * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
6477 * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
6478 * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
6479 *
6480 * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
6481 * manner.
6482 *
6483 * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
6484 * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
6485 * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
6486 * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
6487 * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
6488 * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
6489 * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
6490 * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
6491 * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
6492 * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
6493 * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
6494 * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
6495 * woke up while blocked or not.
6496 */
6497 void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6498 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
6499
6500 /**
6501 * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP
6502 * @pubsta: the station
6503 *
6504 * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell
6505 * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the
6506 * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead.
6507 * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD.
6508 *
6509 * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must
6510 * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function
6511 * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or
6512 * all non-irqsafe, don't mix!
6513 *
6514 * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no
6515 * driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if
6516 * you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history
6517 * and restore the _irqsafe version!
6518 */
6519 void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6520
6521 /**
6522 * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP
6523 * @pubsta: the station
6524 * @tid: the tid of the NDP
6525 *
6526 * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close
6527 * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when
6528 * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window.
6529 * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a
6530 * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the
6531 * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to
6532 * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any
6533 * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong.
6534 * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame
6535 * will be sent despite the station being in power-save.
6536 * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames().
6537 * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver
6538 * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call
6539 * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent.
6540 */
6541 void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid);
6542
6543 /**
6544 * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates - recalculate aggregate data after a change
6545 * @pubsta: the station
6546 *
6547 * Call this function after changing a per-link aggregate data as referenced in
6548 * &struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates by accessing the agg field of
6549 * &struct ieee80211_link_sta.
6550 *
6551 * With non MLO the data in deflink will be referenced directly. In that case
6552 * there is no need to call this function.
6553 */
6554 void ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6555
6556 /**
6557 * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid
6558 *
6559 * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call
6560 * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of
6561 * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule
6562 * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness.
6563 *
6564 * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent
6565 * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not
6566 * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the
6567 * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame
6568 * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission
6569 * attempts.
6570 *
6571 * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or
6572 * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available.
6573 * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of
6574 * them to 0.
6575 *
6576 * @pubsta: the station
6577 * @tid: the TID to register airtime for
6578 * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec)
6579 * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec)
6580 */
6581 void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6582 u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime);
6583
6584 /**
6585 * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device
6586 *
6587 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6588 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6589 *
6590 * Return: %true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can
6591 * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return %false.
6592 */
6593 bool
6594 ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6595
6596 /**
6597 * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
6598 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6599 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6600 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6601 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6602 *
6603 * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; can sleep.
6604 *
6605 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6606 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6607 * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
6608 * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend.
6609 *
6610 * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
6611 * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
6612 * set_key callback.
6613 */
6614 void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6615 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6616 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6617 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6618 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6619 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6620 void *data),
6621 void *iter_data);
6622
6623 /**
6624 * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device
6625 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6626 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6627 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6628 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6629 *
6630 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6631 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6632 * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station
6633 * in removal process will be skipped.
6634 *
6635 * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section,
6636 * and thus iter must be atomic.
6637 */
6638 void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6639 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6640 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6641 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6642 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6643 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6644 void *data),
6645 void *iter_data);
6646
6647 /**
6648 * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts
6649 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6650 * @iter: iterator function
6651 * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
6652 *
6653 * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and
6654 * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other
6655 * places while calling into the driver.
6656 *
6657 * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
6658 * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
6659 * removed.
6660 *
6661 * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
6662 * before the restart are considered already present so will be
6663 * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
6664 * or not.
6665 */
6666 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic(
6667 struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6668 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6669 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
6670 void *data),
6671 void *iter_data);
6672
6673 /**
6674 * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
6675 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6676 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6677 *
6678 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
6679 * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
6680 * information. This function must only be called from within the
6681 * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
6682 * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
6683 * %NULL.
6684 *
6685 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
6686 */
6687 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6688 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6689
6690 /**
6691 * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
6692 *
6693 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6694 *
6695 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and
6696 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
6697 * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
6698 */
6699 void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6700
6701 /**
6702 * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
6703 *
6704 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6705 *
6706 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and
6707 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
6708 * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
6709 * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated
6710 * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set.
6711 *
6712 * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
6713 * without connection recovery attempts.
6714 */
6715 void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6716
6717 /**
6718 * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection
6719 *
6720 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6721 * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired
6722 *
6723 * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a
6724 * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired.
6725 */
6726 void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect);
6727
6728 /**
6729 * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
6730 *
6731 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6732 *
6733 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
6734 * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
6735 * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
6736 * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
6737 * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
6738 *
6739 * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
6740 * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
6741 * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
6742 * disconnect normally later.
6743 *
6744 * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
6745 * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
6746 * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
6747 * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
6748 */
6749 void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6750
6751 /**
6752 * ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect - disconnect from AP after
6753 * hardware restart
6754 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6755 *
6756 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after
6757 * hardware restart.
6758 */
6759 void ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6760
6761 /**
6762 * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
6763 * rssi threshold triggered
6764 *
6765 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6766 * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
6767 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
6768 * @gfp: context flags
6769 *
6770 * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
6771 * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
6772 * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
6773 */
6774 void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6775 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
6776 s32 rssi_level,
6777 gfp_t gfp);
6778
6779 /**
6780 * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss
6781 *
6782 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6783 * @gfp: context flags
6784 */
6785 void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp);
6786
6787 /**
6788 * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected
6789 *
6790 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6791 * @chanctx_conf: Channel context on which radar is detected. Mandatory to
6792 * pass a valid pointer during MLO. For non-MLO %NULL can be passed
6793 */
6794 void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6795 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf);
6796
6797 /**
6798 * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
6799 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6800 * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
6801 * @link_id: the link_id on which the switch was done. Ignored if success is
6802 * false.
6803 *
6804 * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
6805 * and wake up the suspended queues.
6806 */
6807 void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success,
6808 unsigned int link_id);
6809
6810 /**
6811 * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error
6812 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6813 *
6814 * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel
6815 * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send
6816 * a deauth frame in this case.
6817 */
6818 void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6819
6820 /**
6821 * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
6822 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6823 * @link_id: link ID for MLO, or 0
6824 * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
6825 *
6826 * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
6827 * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
6828 * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
6829 */
6830 void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6831 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
6832
6833 /**
6834 * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
6835 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6836 */
6837 void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6838
6839 /**
6840 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
6841 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6842 */
6843 void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6844
6845 /**
6846 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
6847 *
6848 * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
6849 * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
6850 * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
6851 * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
6852 * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
6853 * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
6854 *
6855 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6856 * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
6857 * @addr: & to bssid mac address
6858 */
6859 void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
6860 const u8 *addr);
6861
6862 /**
6863 * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered
6864 * @pubsta: station struct
6865 * @tid: the session's TID
6866 * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are
6867 * assumed to be out of the window after the call
6868 * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc.
6869 * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware
6870 *
6871 * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and
6872 * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it
6873 * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released
6874 * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.)
6875 * (Only work correctly if @max_rx_aggregation_subframes <= 64 frames)
6876 */
6877 void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6878 u16 ssn, u64 filtered,
6879 u16 received_mpdus);
6880
6881 /**
6882 * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame
6883 *
6884 * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder
6885 * buffer.
6886 *
6887 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6888 * @ra: the peer's destination address
6889 * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session
6890 * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver
6891 */
6892 void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn);
6893
6894 /**
6895 * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work
6896 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6897 * @addr: station mac address
6898 * @tid: the rx tid
6899 */
6900 void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr,
6901 unsigned int tid);
6902
6903 /**
6904 * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session
6905 *
6906 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6907 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6908 * reordering.
6909 *
6910 * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6911 * when they complete AddBa negotiation.
6912 *
6913 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6914 * @addr: station mac address
6915 * @tid: the rx tid
6916 */
ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif * vif,const u8 * addr,u16 tid)6917 static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6918 const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6919 {
6920 if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6921 return;
6922 ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid);
6923 }
6924
6925 /**
6926 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session
6927 *
6928 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6929 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6930 * reordering.
6931 *
6932 * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6933 * when they complete DelBa negotiation.
6934 *
6935 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6936 * @addr: station mac address
6937 * @tid: the rx tid
6938 */
ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif * vif,const u8 * addr,u16 tid)6939 static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6940 const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6941 {
6942 if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6943 return;
6944 ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS);
6945 }
6946
6947 /**
6948 * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout
6949 *
6950 * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx
6951 * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer.
6952 *
6953 * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa.
6954 *
6955 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6956 * @addr: station mac address
6957 * @tid: the rx tid
6958 */
6959 void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6960 const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid);
6961
6962 /* Rate control API */
6963
6964 /**
6965 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
6966 *
6967 * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
6968 * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
6969 * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
6970 * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
6971 * to be filled in
6972 * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
6973 * which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
6974 * used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
6975 * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
6976 * RTS threshold
6977 * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
6978 * if the selected rate supports it
6979 * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask
6980 * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use)
6981 * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
6982 */
6983 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
6984 struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
6985 struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
6986 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
6987 struct sk_buff *skb;
6988 struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
6989 bool rts, short_preamble;
6990 u32 rate_idx_mask;
6991 u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask;
6992 bool bss;
6993 };
6994
6995 /**
6996 * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities
6997 */
6998 enum rate_control_capabilities {
6999 /**
7000 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW:
7001 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable)
7002 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains
7003 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has,
7004 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us.
7005 */
7006 RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0),
7007 /**
7008 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER:
7009 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx
7010 */
7011 RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1),
7012 };
7013
7014 struct rate_control_ops {
7015 unsigned long capa;
7016 const char *name;
7017 void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
7018 void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv,
7019 struct dentry *debugfsdir);
7020 void (*free)(void *priv);
7021
7022 void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
7023 void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7024 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7025 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
7026 void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7027 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7028 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7029 u32 changed);
7030 void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
7031 void *priv_sta);
7032
7033 void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv,
7034 struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7035 void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st);
7036 void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7037 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7038 struct sk_buff *skb);
7039 void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7040 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
7041
7042 void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
7043 struct dentry *dir);
7044
7045 u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta);
7046 };
7047
rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta * sta,enum nl80211_band band,int index)7048 static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
7049 enum nl80211_band band,
7050 int index)
7051 {
7052 return (sta == NULL || sta->deflink.supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
7053 }
7054
7055 static inline s8
rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_sta * sta)7056 rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7057 struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
7058 {
7059 int i;
7060
7061 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
7062 if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
7063 return i;
7064
7065 /* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
7066 WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
7067
7068 /* and return 0 (the lowest index) */
7069 return 0;
7070 }
7071
7072 static inline
rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_sta * sta)7073 bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7074 struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
7075 {
7076 unsigned int i;
7077
7078 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
7079 if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
7080 return true;
7081 return false;
7082 }
7083
7084 /**
7085 * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver
7086 *
7087 * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass
7088 * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station
7089 * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on
7090 * the most recent rate control module decision.
7091 *
7092 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7093 * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination.
7094 * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station.
7095 *
7096 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
7097 */
7098 int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7099 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
7100 struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates);
7101
7102 int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
7103 void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
7104
7105 static inline bool
conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7106 conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7107 {
7108 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
7109 }
7110
7111 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7112 conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7113 {
7114 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
7115 conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
7116 }
7117
7118 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7119 conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7120 {
7121 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
7122 conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
7123 }
7124
7125 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7126 conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7127 {
7128 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40;
7129 }
7130
7131 static inline bool
conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7132 conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7133 {
7134 return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) &&
7135 (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) &&
7136 (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT);
7137 }
7138
7139 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type,bool p2p)7140 ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
7141 {
7142 if (p2p) {
7143 switch (type) {
7144 case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
7145 return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
7146 case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
7147 return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
7148 default:
7149 break;
7150 }
7151 }
7152 return type;
7153 }
7154
7155 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7156 ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7157 {
7158 return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
7159 }
7160
7161 /**
7162 * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif - return HE capabilities for sband/vif
7163 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
7164 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7165 *
7166 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or %NULL is none found
7167 */
7168 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7169 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7170 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7171 {
7172 return ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7173 }
7174
7175 /**
7176 * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
7177 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
7178 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7179 *
7180 * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
7181 */
7182 static inline __le16
ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7183 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7184 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7185 {
7186 return ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7187 }
7188
7189 /**
7190 * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif - return ETH capabilities for sband/vif
7191 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
7192 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7193 *
7194 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or %NULL is none found
7195 */
7196 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap *
ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7197 ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7198 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7199 {
7200 return ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7201 }
7202
7203 /**
7204 * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data
7205 *
7206 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
7207 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, otherwise 0
7208 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
7209 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
7210 *
7211 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and
7212 * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the
7213 * matching GroupId management frame.
7214 * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path.
7215 */
7216 void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
7217 const u8 *membership, const u8 *position);
7218
7219 void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7220 int rssi_min_thold,
7221 int rssi_max_thold);
7222
7223 void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7224
7225 /**
7226 * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface
7227 *
7228 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
7229 *
7230 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid.
7231 *
7232 * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not
7233 * applicable.
7234 */
7235 int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7236
7237 /**
7238 * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup
7239 * @vif: virtual interface
7240 * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s)
7241 * @gfp: allocation flags
7242 *
7243 * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup().
7244 */
7245 void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7246 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
7247 gfp_t gfp);
7248
7249 /**
7250 * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission
7251 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7252 * @vif: virtual interface
7253 * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver
7254 * @band: the band to transmit on
7255 * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to
7256 *
7257 * Return: %true if the skb was prepared, %false otherwise
7258 *
7259 * Note: must be called under RCU lock
7260 */
7261 bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7262 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb,
7263 int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta);
7264
7265 /**
7266 * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header
7267 * of injected frames.
7268 *
7269 * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields,
7270 * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure
7271 * of the skb before calling this function.
7272 *
7273 * @skb: packet injected by userspace
7274 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
7275 *
7276 * Return: %true if the radiotap header was parsed, %false otherwise
7277 */
7278 bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb,
7279 struct net_device *dev);
7280
7281 /**
7282 * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state
7283 *
7284 * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change
7285 * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending
7286 *
7287 * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent
7288 *
7289 * private:
7290 *
7291 * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors
7292 * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA
7293 */
7294 struct ieee80211_noa_data {
7295 u32 next_tsf;
7296 bool has_next_tsf;
7297
7298 u8 absent;
7299
7300 u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7301 struct {
7302 u32 start;
7303 u32 duration;
7304 u32 interval;
7305 } desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7306 };
7307
7308 /**
7309 * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE
7310 *
7311 * @attr: P2P NoA IE
7312 * @data: NoA tracking data
7313 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7314 *
7315 * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors
7316 */
7317 int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr,
7318 struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7319
7320 /**
7321 * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change
7322 *
7323 * @data: NoA tracking data
7324 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7325 */
7326 void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7327
7328 /**
7329 * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation
7330 * @vif: virtual interface
7331 * @peer: the peer's destination address
7332 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation
7333 * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown
7334 * @gfp: allocation flags
7335 *
7336 * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request().
7337 */
7338 void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer,
7339 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
7340 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
7341
7342 /**
7343 * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID
7344 *
7345 * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from
7346 * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such
7347 * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID,
7348 * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks
7349 * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be
7350 * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC.
7351 *
7352 * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it
7353 * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should
7354 * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7355 *
7356 * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for
7357 * @tid: the TID to reserve
7358 *
7359 * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure
7360 */
7361 int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7362
7363 /**
7364 * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID
7365 *
7366 * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function
7367 * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for
7368 * preventing use of this TID in the driver.
7369 *
7370 * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called
7371 * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called
7372 * from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7373 *
7374 * @sta: the station
7375 * @tid: the TID to unreserve
7376 */
7377 void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7378
7379 /**
7380 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7381 *
7382 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7383 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7384 * ieee80211_next_txq()
7385 *
7386 * Return: the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
7387 *
7388 * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section,
7389 * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in
7390 * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the
7391 * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call
7392 * but for the duration of the frame handling.
7393 * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method,
7394 * rcu_read_lock() is already held.
7395 *
7396 * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called.
7397 * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead.
7398 */
7399 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7400 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7401
7402 /**
7403 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7404 * (in process context)
7405 *
7406 * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context
7407 * (internally disables bottom halves).
7408 *
7409 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7410 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7411 * ieee80211_next_txq()
7412 *
7413 * Return: the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
7414 */
ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq)7415 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7416 struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7417 {
7418 struct sk_buff *skb;
7419
7420 local_bh_disable();
7421 skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq);
7422 local_bh_enable();
7423
7424 return skb;
7425 }
7426
7427 /**
7428 * ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue - mac80211 handler for wake_tx_queue callback
7429 *
7430 * @hw: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7431 * @txq: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7432 *
7433 * Drivers can use this function for the mandatory mac80211 wake_tx_queue
7434 * callback in struct ieee80211_ops. They should not call this function.
7435 */
7436 void ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7437 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7438
7439 /**
7440 * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from
7441 *
7442 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7443 * @ac: AC number to return packets from.
7444 *
7445 * Return: the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq
7446 * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the
7447 * driver has finished scheduling it.
7448 */
7449 struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7450
7451 /**
7452 * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs
7453 *
7454 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7455 * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for
7456 *
7457 * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq().
7458 * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently.
7459 */
7460 void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7461
7462 /* (deprecated) */
ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,u8 ac)7463 static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac)
7464 {
7465 }
7466
7467 void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7468 struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force);
7469
7470 /**
7471 * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission
7472 *
7473 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7474 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7475 *
7476 * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled,
7477 * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered.
7478 *
7479 * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for
7480 * this TXQ internally.
7481 */
7482 static inline void
ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq)7483 ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7484 {
7485 __ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true);
7486 }
7487
7488 /**
7489 * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq()
7490 *
7491 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7492 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7493 * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets.
7494 *
7495 * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ
7496 * internally.
7497 */
7498 static inline void
ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq,bool force)7499 ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7500 bool force)
7501 {
7502 __ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force);
7503 }
7504
7505 /**
7506 * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit
7507 *
7508 * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by
7509 * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime
7510 * fairness accounting without using the scheduling order enforced by
7511 * next_txq().
7512 *
7513 * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to
7514 * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have
7515 * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will
7516 * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit
7517 * again.
7518 *
7519 * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be
7520 * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates
7521 * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry
7522 * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this
7523 * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets
7524 * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq().
7525 *
7526 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7527 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7528 *
7529 * Return: %true if transmission is allowed, %false otherwise
7530 */
7531 bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7532 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7533
7534 /**
7535 * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq
7536 *
7537 * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e.
7538 * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up
7539 * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa.
7540 *
7541 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7542 * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count
7543 * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count
7544 */
7545 void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7546 unsigned long *frame_cnt,
7547 unsigned long *byte_cnt);
7548
7549 /**
7550 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
7551 *
7552 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination.
7553 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7554 *
7555 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7556 * @inst_id: the local instance id
7557 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
7558 * @gfp: allocation flags
7559 */
7560 void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7561 u8 inst_id,
7562 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
7563 gfp_t gfp);
7564
7565 /**
7566 * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event.
7567 *
7568 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The
7569 * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211.
7570 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7571 *
7572 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7573 * @match: match event information
7574 * @gfp: allocation flags
7575 */
7576 void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7577 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match,
7578 gfp_t gfp);
7579
7580 /**
7581 * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX.
7582 *
7583 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7584 * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length.
7585 *
7586 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7587 * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate
7588 * information.
7589 * @len: frame length in bytes
7590 *
7591 * Return: the airtime estimate
7592 */
7593 u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7594 struct ieee80211_rx_status *status,
7595 int len);
7596
7597 /**
7598 * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX.
7599 *
7600 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7601 * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length.
7602 *
7603 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7604 * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
7605 * @len: frame length in bytes
7606 *
7607 * Return: the airtime estimate
7608 */
7609 u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7610 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info,
7611 int len);
7612 /**
7613 * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template.
7614 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7615 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7616 *
7617 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7618 *
7619 * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error.
7620 */
7621 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7622 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7623
7624 /**
7625 * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast
7626 * probe response template.
7627 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7628 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7629 *
7630 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7631 *
7632 * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error.
7633 */
7634 struct sk_buff *
7635 ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7636 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7637
7638 /**
7639 * ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color
7640 * collision.
7641 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
7642 *
7643 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7644 * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is
7645 * aware of.
7646 */
7647 void
7648 ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7649 u64 color_bitmap, u8 link_id);
7650
7651 /**
7652 * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame
7653 *
7654 * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with
7655 * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames.
7656 *
7657 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
7658 *
7659 * Return: %true if @skb is a data frame, %false otherwise
7660 */
ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff * skb)7661 static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb)
7662 {
7663 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb);
7664 struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data;
7665
7666 return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP ||
7667 ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control);
7668 }
7669
7670 /**
7671 * ieee80211_set_active_links - set active links in client mode
7672 * @vif: interface to set active links on
7673 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7674 *
7675 * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; may sleep; calls
7676 * back into the driver.
7677 *
7678 * This changes the active links on an interface. The interface
7679 * must be in client mode (in AP mode, all links are always active),
7680 * and @active_links must be a subset of the vif's valid_links.
7681 *
7682 * If a link is switched off and another is switched on at the same
7683 * time (e.g. active_links going from 0x1 to 0x10) then you will get
7684 * a sequence of calls like
7685 *
7686 * - change_vif_links(0x11)
7687 * - unassign_vif_chanctx(link_id=0)
7688 * - assign_vif_chanctx(link_id=4)
7689 * - change_sta_links(0x11) for each affected STA (the AP)
7690 * (TDLS connections on now inactive links should be torn down)
7691 * - remove group keys on the old link (link_id 0)
7692 * - add new group keys (GTK/IGTK/BIGTK) on the new link (link_id 4)
7693 * - change_sta_links(0x10) for each affected STA (the AP)
7694 * - change_vif_links(0x10)
7695 *
7696 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
7697 */
7698 int ieee80211_set_active_links(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 active_links);
7699
7700 /**
7701 * ieee80211_set_active_links_async - asynchronously set active links
7702 * @vif: interface to set active links on
7703 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7704 *
7705 * See ieee80211_set_active_links() for more information, the only
7706 * difference here is that the link change is triggered async and
7707 * can be called in any context, but the link switch will only be
7708 * completed after it returns.
7709 */
7710 void ieee80211_set_active_links_async(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7711 u16 active_links);
7712
7713 /**
7714 * ieee80211_send_teardown_neg_ttlm - tear down a negotiated TTLM request
7715 * @vif: the interface on which the tear down request should be sent.
7716 *
7717 * This function can be used to tear down a previously accepted negotiated
7718 * TTLM request.
7719 */
7720 void ieee80211_send_teardown_neg_ttlm(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7721
7722 /**
7723 * ieee80211_chan_width_to_rx_bw - convert channel width to STA RX bandwidth
7724 * @width: the channel width value to convert
7725 * Return: the STA RX bandwidth value for the channel width
7726 */
7727 static inline enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth
ieee80211_chan_width_to_rx_bw(enum nl80211_chan_width width)7728 ieee80211_chan_width_to_rx_bw(enum nl80211_chan_width width)
7729 {
7730 switch (width) {
7731 default:
7732 WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
7733 fallthrough;
7734 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT:
7735 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20:
7736 return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20;
7737 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40:
7738 return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40;
7739 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80:
7740 return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80;
7741 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160:
7742 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80:
7743 return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160;
7744 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_320:
7745 return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320;
7746 }
7747 }
7748
7749 /**
7750 * ieee80211_prepare_rx_omi_bw - prepare for sending BW RX OMI
7751 * @link_sta: the link STA the OMI is going to be sent to
7752 * @bw: the bandwidth requested
7753 *
7754 * When the driver decides to do RX OMI to change bandwidth with a STA
7755 * it calls this function to prepare, then sends the OMI, and finally
7756 * calls ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw().
7757 *
7758 * Note that the (link) STA rate control is updated accordingly as well,
7759 * but the chanctx might not be updated if there are other users.
7760 * If the intention is to reduce the listen bandwidth, the driver must
7761 * ensure there are no TDLS stations nor other uses of the chanctx.
7762 *
7763 * Also note that in order to sequence correctly, narrowing bandwidth
7764 * will only happen in ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw(), whereas widening
7765 * again (e.g. going back to normal) will happen here.
7766 *
7767 * Note that we treat this symmetrically, so if the driver calls this
7768 * and tells the peer to only send with a lower bandwidth, we assume
7769 * that the driver also wants to only send at that lower bandwidth, to
7770 * allow narrowing of the chanctx request for this station/interface.
7771 *
7772 * Finally, the driver must ensure that if the function returned %true,
7773 * ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw() is also called, even for example in
7774 * case of HW restart.
7775 *
7776 * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held, and will call back
7777 * into the driver, so ensure no driver locks are held.
7778 *
7779 * Return: %true if changes are going to be made, %false otherwise
7780 */
7781 bool ieee80211_prepare_rx_omi_bw(struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
7782 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bw);
7783
7784 /**
7785 * ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw - finalize BW RX OMI update
7786 * @link_sta: the link STA the OMI was sent to
7787 *
7788 * See ieee80211_client_prepare_rx_omi_bw(). Context is the same here
7789 * as well.
7790 */
7791 void ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw(struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta);
7792
7793 /* for older drivers - let's not document these ... */
7794 int ieee80211_emulate_add_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7795 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
7796 void ieee80211_emulate_remove_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7797 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
7798 void ieee80211_emulate_change_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7799 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
7800 u32 changed);
7801 int ieee80211_emulate_switch_vif_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7802 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
7803 int n_vifs,
7804 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
7805
7806 #endif /* MAC80211_H */
7807